xref: /linux/include/uapi/linux/nl80211.h (revision 8be4d31cb8aaeea27bde4b7ddb26e28a89062ebf)
1 #ifndef __LINUX_NL80211_H
2 #define __LINUX_NL80211_H
3 /*
4  * 802.11 netlink interface public header
5  *
6  * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
7  * Copyright 2008 Michael Wu <flamingice@sourmilk.net>
8  * Copyright 2008 Luis Carlos Cobo <luisca@cozybit.com>
9  * Copyright 2008 Michael Buesch <m@bues.ch>
10  * Copyright 2008, 2009 Luis R. Rodriguez <lrodriguez@atheros.com>
11  * Copyright 2008 Jouni Malinen <jouni.malinen@atheros.com>
12  * Copyright 2008 Colin McCabe <colin@cozybit.com>
13  * Copyright 2015-2017	Intel Deutschland GmbH
14  * Copyright (C) 2018-2025 Intel Corporation
15  *
16  * Permission to use, copy, modify, and/or distribute this software for any
17  * purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above
18  * copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies.
19  *
20  * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND THE AUTHOR DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES
21  * WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
22  * MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR
23  * ANY SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
24  * WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN
25  * ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF
26  * OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
27  *
28  */
29 
30 /*
31  * This header file defines the userspace API to the wireless stack. Please
32  * be careful not to break things - i.e. don't move anything around or so
33  * unless you can demonstrate that it breaks neither API nor ABI.
34  *
35  * Additions to the API should be accompanied by actual implementations in
36  * an upstream driver, so that example implementations exist in case there
37  * are ever concerns about the precise semantics of the API or changes are
38  * needed, and to ensure that code for dead (no longer implemented) API
39  * can actually be identified and removed.
40  * Nonetheless, semantics should also be documented carefully in this file.
41  */
42 
43 #include <linux/types.h>
44 
45 #define NL80211_GENL_NAME "nl80211"
46 
47 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_CONFIG		"config"
48 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_SCAN		"scan"
49 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_REG		"regulatory"
50 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_MLME		"mlme"
51 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_VENDOR		"vendor"
52 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_NAN		"nan"
53 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_TESTMODE	"testmode"
54 
55 #define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MIN	4
56 #define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MAX	15
57 #define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MIN	1
58 #define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MAX	0x3c /* 0b00111100 */
59 
60 /**
61  * DOC: Station handling
62  *
63  * Stations are added per interface, but a special case exists with VLAN
64  * interfaces. When a station is bound to an AP interface, it may be moved
65  * into a VLAN identified by a VLAN interface index (%NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN).
66  * The station is still assumed to belong to the AP interface it was added
67  * to.
68  *
69  * Station handling varies per interface type and depending on the driver's
70  * capabilities.
71  *
72  * For drivers supporting TDLS with external setup (WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS
73  * and WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP), the station lifetime is as follows:
74  *  - a setup station entry is added, not yet authorized, without any rate
75  *    or capability information; this just exists to avoid race conditions
76  *  - when the TDLS setup is done, a single NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION is valid
77  *    to add rate and capability information to the station and at the same
78  *    time mark it authorized.
79  *  - %NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK is then used
80  *  - after this, the only valid operation is to remove it by tearing down
81  *    the TDLS link (%NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK)
82  *
83  * TODO: need more info for other interface types
84  */
85 
86 /**
87  * DOC: Frame transmission/registration support
88  *
89  * Frame transmission and registration support exists to allow userspace
90  * management entities such as wpa_supplicant to react to management frames
91  * that are not being handled by the kernel. This includes, for example,
92  * certain classes of action frames that cannot be handled in the kernel
93  * for various reasons.
94  *
95  * Frame registration is done on a per-interface basis and registrations
96  * cannot be removed other than by closing the socket. It is possible to
97  * specify a registration filter to register, for example, only for a
98  * certain type of action frame. In particular with action frames, those
99  * that userspace registers for will not be returned as unhandled by the
100  * driver, so that the registered application has to take responsibility
101  * for doing that.
102  *
103  * The type of frame that can be registered for is also dependent on the
104  * driver and interface type. The frame types are advertised in wiphy
105  * attributes so applications know what to expect.
106  *
107  * NOTE: When an interface changes type while registrations are active,
108  *       these registrations are ignored until the interface type is
109  *       changed again. This means that changing the interface type can
110  *       lead to a situation that couldn't otherwise be produced, but
111  *       any such registrations will be dormant in the sense that they
112  *       will not be serviced, i.e. they will not receive any frames.
113  *
114  * Frame transmission allows userspace to send for example the required
115  * responses to action frames. It is subject to some sanity checking,
116  * but many frames can be transmitted. When a frame is transmitted, its
117  * status is indicated to the sending socket.
118  *
119  * For more technical details, see the corresponding command descriptions
120  * below.
121  */
122 
123 /**
124  * DOC: Virtual interface / concurrency capabilities
125  *
126  * Some devices are able to operate with virtual MACs; they can have
127  * more than one virtual interface. The capability handling for this
128  * is a bit complex though, as there may be a number of restrictions
129  * on the types of concurrency that are supported.
130  *
131  * To start with, each device supports the interface types listed in
132  * the %NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES attribute, but by listing the
133  * types there no concurrency is implied.
134  *
135  * Once concurrency is desired, more attributes must be observed:
136  * To start with, since some interface types are purely managed in
137  * software, like the AP-VLAN type in mac80211 for example, there's
138  * an additional list of these; they can be added at any time and
139  * are only restricted by some semantic restrictions (e.g. AP-VLAN
140  * cannot be added without a corresponding AP interface). This list
141  * is exported in the %NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES attribute.
142  *
143  * Further, the list of supported combinations is exported. This is
144  * in the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute. Basically,
145  * it exports a list of "groups", and at any point in time the
146  * interfaces that are currently active must fall into any one of
147  * the advertised groups. Within each group, there are restrictions
148  * on the number of interfaces of different types that are supported
149  * and also the number of different channels, along with potentially
150  * some other restrictions. See &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
151  *
152  * All together, these attributes define the concurrency of virtual
153  * interfaces that a given device supports.
154  */
155 
156 /**
157  * DOC: packet coalesce support
158  *
159  * In most cases, host that receives IPv4 and IPv6 multicast/broadcast
160  * packets does not do anything with these packets. Therefore the
161  * reception of these unwanted packets causes unnecessary processing
162  * and power consumption.
163  *
164  * Packet coalesce feature helps to reduce number of received interrupts
165  * to host by buffering these packets in firmware/hardware for some
166  * predefined time. Received interrupt will be generated when one of the
167  * following events occurs.
168  * a) Expiration of hardware timer whose expiration time is set to maximum
169  * coalescing delay of matching coalesce rule.
170  * b) Coalescing buffer in hardware reaches its limit.
171  * c) Packet doesn't match any of the configured coalesce rules.
172  *
173  * User needs to configure following parameters for creating a coalesce
174  * rule.
175  * a) Maximum coalescing delay
176  * b) List of packet patterns which needs to be matched
177  * c) Condition for coalescence: pattern 'match' or 'no match'
178  * Multiple such rules can be created.
179  */
180 
181 /**
182  * DOC: WPA/WPA2 EAPOL handshake offload
183  *
184  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK flag drivers
185  * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2
186  * preshared key authentication in station mode. In %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
187  * the preshared key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers
188  * supporting this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when no
189  * preshared key material is provided, for example when that driver does
190  * not support setting the temporal keys through %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY.
191  *
192  * Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X flag can be
193  * set by drivers indicating offload support of the PTK/GTK EAPOL
194  * handshakes during 802.1X authentication in station mode. In order to
195  * use the offload the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT should have
196  * %NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS attribute flag. Drivers supporting this
197  * offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when the attribute flag is
198  * not present.
199  *
200  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK flag drivers
201  * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2
202  * preshared key authentication in AP mode. In %NL80211_CMD_START_AP
203  * the preshared key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers
204  * supporting this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_START_AP when no
205  * preshared key material is provided, for example when that driver does
206  * not support setting the temporal keys through %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY.
207  *
208  * For 802.1X the PMK or PMK-R0 are set by providing %NL80211_ATTR_PMK
209  * using %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT support also
210  * %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME must be provided.
211  */
212 
213 /**
214  * DOC: FILS shared key authentication offload
215  *
216  * FILS shared key authentication offload can be advertised by drivers by
217  * setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD flag. The drivers that support
218  * FILS shared key authentication offload should be able to construct the
219  * authentication and association frames for FILS shared key authentication and
220  * eventually do a key derivation as per IEEE 802.11ai. The below additional
221  * parameters should be given to driver in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and/or in
222  * %NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS.
223  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME - used to construct keyname_nai
224  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM - used to construct keyname_nai
225  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used to construct erp message
226  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK - used to generate the rIK and rMSK
227  * rIK should be used to generate an authentication tag on the ERP message and
228  * rMSK should be used to derive a PMKSA.
229  * rIK, rMSK should be generated and keyname_nai, sequence number should be used
230  * as specified in IETF RFC 6696.
231  *
232  * When FILS shared key authentication is completed, driver needs to provide the
233  * below additional parameters to userspace, which can be either after setting
234  * up a connection or after roaming.
235  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - used for key renewal
236  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used in further EAP-RP exchanges
237  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PMKID - used to identify the PMKSA used/generated
238  *	%Nl80211_ATTR_PMK - used to update PMKSA cache in userspace
239  * The PMKSA can be maintained in userspace persistently so that it can be used
240  * later after reboots or wifi turn off/on also.
241  *
242  * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the cache identifier advertised by a FILS
243  * capable AP supporting PMK caching. It specifies the scope within which the
244  * PMKSAs are cached in an ESS. %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and
245  * %NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA are enhanced to allow support for PMKSA caching based
246  * on FILS cache identifier. Additionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK is used with
247  * %NL80211_SET_PMKSA to specify the PMK corresponding to a PMKSA for driver to
248  * use in a FILS shared key connection with PMKSA caching.
249  */
250 
251 /**
252  * DOC: SAE authentication offload
253  *
254  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they
255  * support offloading SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks in station
256  * mode. Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP flag can be set by
257  * drivers indicating the offload support in AP mode.
258  *
259  * The password for SAE should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD in
260  * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP for station and AP mode
261  * respectively.
262  */
263 
264 /**
265  * DOC: VLAN offload support for setting group keys and binding STAs to VLANs
266  *
267  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they
268  * support offloading VLAN functionality in a manner where the driver exposes a
269  * single netdev that uses VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs
270  * can then be added using RTM_NEWLINK/IFLA_VLAN_ID similarly to the Ethernet
271  * case. Frames received from stations that are not assigned to any VLAN are
272  * delivered on the main netdev and frames to such stations can be sent through
273  * that main netdev.
274  *
275  * %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY (for group keys), %NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION, and
276  * %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION will optionally specify vlan_id using
277  * %NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID.
278  */
279 
280 /**
281  * DOC: TID configuration
282  *
283  * TID config support can be checked in the %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG
284  * attribute given in wiphy capabilities.
285  *
286  * The necessary configuration parameters are mentioned in
287  * &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr and it will be passed to the
288  * %NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG command in %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG.
289  *
290  * If the configuration needs to be applied for specific peer then the MAC
291  * address of the peer needs to be passed in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, otherwise the
292  * configuration will be applied for all the connected peers in the vif except
293  * any peers that have peer-specific configuration for the TID by default; if
294  * the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE flag is set, peer-specific values
295  * will be overwritten.
296  *
297  * All this configuration is valid only for STA's current connection,
298  * i.e., the configuration will be reset to default when the STA connects back
299  * after disconnection/roaming, and this configuration will be cleared when
300  * the interface goes down.
301  */
302 
303 /**
304  * DOC: FILS shared key crypto offload
305  *
306  * This feature is applicable to drivers running in AP mode.
307  *
308  * FILS shared key crypto offload can be advertised by drivers by setting
309  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD flag. The drivers that support
310  * FILS shared key crypto offload should be able to encrypt and decrypt
311  * association frames for FILS shared key authentication as per IEEE 802.11ai.
312  * With this capability, for FILS key derivation, drivers depend on userspace.
313  *
314  * After FILS key derivation, userspace shares the FILS AAD details with the
315  * driver and the driver stores the same to use in decryption of association
316  * request and in encryption of association response. The below parameters
317  * should be given to the driver in %NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD.
318  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC - STA MAC address, used for storing FILS AAD per STA
319  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - Used for encryption or decryption
320  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES - Used for encryption or decryption
321  *			(STA Nonce 16 bytes followed by AP Nonce 16 bytes)
322  *
323  * Once the association is done, the driver cleans the FILS AAD data.
324  */
325 
326 /**
327  * DOC: Multi-Link Operation
328  *
329  * In Multi-Link Operation, a connection between two MLDs utilizes multiple
330  * links. To use this in nl80211, various commands and responses now need
331  * to or will include the new %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS attribute.
332  * Additionally, various commands that need to operate on a specific link
333  * now need to be given the %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID attribute, e.g. to
334  * use %NL80211_CMD_START_AP or similar functions.
335  */
336 
337 /**
338  * DOC: OWE DH IE handling offload
339  *
340  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD flag, drivers can indicate
341  * kernel/application space to avoid DH IE handling. When this flag is
342  * advertised, the driver/device will take care of DH IE inclusion and
343  * processing of peer DH IE to generate PMK.
344  */
345 
346 /**
347  * enum nl80211_commands - supported nl80211 commands
348  *
349  * @NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC: unspecified command to catch errors
350  *
351  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY: request information about a wiphy or dump request
352  *	to get a list of all present wiphys.
353  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY: set wiphy parameters, needs %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or
354  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX; can be used to set %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME,
355  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
356  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET (and the attributes determining the
357  *	channel width; this is used for setting monitor mode channel),
358  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG,
359  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD, and/or
360  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD.  However, for setting the channel,
361  *	see %NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL instead, the support here is for backward
362  *	compatibility only.
363  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY: Newly created wiphy, response to get request
364  *	or rename notification. Has attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and
365  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME.
366  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY: Wiphy deleted. Has attributes
367  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME.
368  *
369  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE: Request an interface's configuration;
370  *	either a dump request for all interfaces or a specific get with a
371  *	single %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is supported.
372  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE: Set type of a virtual interface, requires
373  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE.
374  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE: Newly created virtual interface or response
375  *	to %NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE. Has %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX,
376  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE attributes. Can also
377  *	be sent from userspace to request creation of a new virtual interface,
378  *	then requires attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE and
379  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME.
380  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE: Virtual interface was deleted, has attributes
381  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY. Can also be sent from
382  *	userspace to request deletion of a virtual interface, then requires
383  *	attribute %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. If multiple BSSID advertisements are
384  *	enabled using %NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG, %NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS,
385  *	and if this command is used for the transmitting interface, then all
386  *	the non-transmitting interfaces are deleted as well.
387  *
388  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY: Get sequence counter information for a key specified
389  *	by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX and/or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
390  *	represents peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. For MLO group key,
391  *	the link is identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
392  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY: Set key attributes %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT,
393  *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT, or %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_THRESHOLD.
394  *	For MLO connection, the link to set default key is identified by
395  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
396  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY: add a key with given %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA,
397  *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER,
398  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ attributes. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC represents
399  *	peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. The link to add MLO
400  *	group key is identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
401  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY: delete a key identified by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX
402  *	or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC represents peer's MLD address
403  *	for MLO pairwise key. The link to delete group key is identified by
404  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
405  *
406  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON: (not used)
407  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON: change the beacon on an access point interface
408  *	using the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD and %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL
409  *	attributes. For drivers that generate the beacon and probe responses
410  *	internally, the following attributes must be provided: %NL80211_ATTR_IE,
411  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP and %NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP.
412  * @NL80211_CMD_START_AP: Start AP operation on an AP interface, parameters
413  *	are like for %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON, and additionally parameters that
414  *	do not change are used, these include %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL,
415  *	%NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD, %NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
416  *	%NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE,
417  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP, %NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS,
418  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES, %NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY,
419  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT,
420  *	%NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS.
421  *	The channel to use can be set on the interface or be given using the
422  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, and the
423  *	attributes determining channel width.
424  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_START_AP
425  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP: Stop AP operation on the given interface
426  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP
427  *
428  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION: Get station attributes for station identified by
429  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
430  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION: Set station attributes for station identified by
431  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
432  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION: Add a station with given attributes to the
433  *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
434  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION: Remove a station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
435  *	or, if no MAC address given, all stations, on the interface identified
436  *	by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. For MLD station, MLD address is used in
437  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE and
438  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE can optionally be used to specify which type
439  *	of disconnection indication should be sent to the station
440  *	(Deauthentication or Disassociation frame and reason code for that
441  *	frame). %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID can be used optionally to remove
442  *	stations connected and using at least that link as one of its links.
443  *
444  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH: Get mesh path attributes for mesh path to
445  *	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
446  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
447  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH:  Set mesh path attributes for mesh path to
448  *	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
449  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
450  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH: Create a new mesh path for the destination given by
451  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC via %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP.
452  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH: Delete a mesh path to the destination given by
453  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
454  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS: Set BSS attributes for BSS identified by
455  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
456  *
457  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_REG: ask the wireless core to send us its currently set
458  *	regulatory domain. If %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is specified and the device
459  *	has a private regulatory domain, it will be returned. Otherwise, the
460  *	global regdomain will be returned.
461  *	A device will have a private regulatory domain if it uses the
462  *	regulatory_hint() API. Even when a private regdomain is used the channel
463  *	information will still be mended according to further hints from
464  *	the regulatory core to help with compliance. A dump version of this API
465  *	is now available which will returns the global regdomain as well as
466  *	all private regdomains of present wiphys (for those that have it).
467  *	If a wiphy is self-managed (%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG), then
468  *	its private regdomain is the only valid one for it. The regulatory
469  *	core is not used to help with compliance in this case.
470  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REG: Set current regulatory domain. CRDA sends this command
471  *	after being queried by the kernel. CRDA replies by sending a regulatory
472  *	domain structure which consists of %NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA set to our
473  *	current alpha2 if it found a match. It also provides
474  *	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS, and a set of regulatory rules. Each
475  *	regulatory rule is a nested set of attributes  given by
476  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FREQ_[START|END] and
477  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW with an attached power rule given by
478  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_ANT_GAIN and
479  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_EIRP.
480  * @NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG: ask the wireless core to set the regulatory domain
481  *	to the specified ISO/IEC 3166-1 alpha2 country code. The core will
482  *	store this as a valid request and then query userspace for it.
483  *
484  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG: Get mesh networking properties for the
485  *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX
486  *
487  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG: Set mesh networking properties for the
488  *      interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX
489  *
490  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE: Set extra IEs for management frames. The
491  *	interface is identified with %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and the management
492  *	frame subtype with %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE. The extra IE data to be
493  *	added to the end of the specified management frame is specified with
494  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IE. If the command succeeds, the requested data will be
495  *	added to all specified management frames generated by
496  *	kernel/firmware/driver.
497  *	Note: This command has been removed and it is only reserved at this
498  *	point to avoid re-using existing command number. The functionality this
499  *	command was planned for has been provided with cleaner design with the
500  *	option to specify additional IEs in NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN,
501  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE,
502  *	NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE, and NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE.
503  *
504  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN: get scan results
505  * @NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN: trigger a new scan with the given parameters
506  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the
507  *	probe requests at CCK rate or not. %NL80211_ATTR_BSSID can be used to
508  *	specify a BSSID to scan for; if not included, the wildcard BSSID will
509  *	be used.
510  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS: scan notification (as a reply to
511  *	NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN and on the "scan" multicast group)
512  * @NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED: scan was aborted, for unspecified reasons,
513  *	partial scan results may be available
514  *
515  * @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN: start a scheduled scan at certain
516  *	intervals and certain number of cycles, as specified by
517  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS. If %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is
518  *	not specified and only %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL is specified,
519  *	scheduled scan will run in an infinite loop with the specified interval.
520  *	These attributes are mutually exclusive,
521  *	i.e. NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL must not be passed if
522  *	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is defined.
523  *	If for some reason scheduled scan is aborted by the driver, all scan
524  *	plans are canceled (including scan plans that did not start yet).
525  *	Like with normal scans, if SSIDs (%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS)
526  *	are passed, they are used in the probe requests.  For
527  *	broadcast, a broadcast SSID must be passed (ie. an empty
528  *	string).  If no SSID is passed, no probe requests are sent and
529  *	a passive scan is performed.  %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES,
530  *	if passed, define which channels should be scanned; if not
531  *	passed, all channels allowed for the current regulatory domain
532  *	are used.  Extra IEs can also be passed from the userspace by
533  *	using the %NL80211_ATTR_IE attribute.  The first cycle of the
534  *	scheduled scan can be delayed by %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY
535  *	is supplied. If the device supports multiple concurrent scheduled
536  *	scans, it will allow such when the caller provides the flag attribute
537  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI to indicate user-space support for it.
538  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN: stop a scheduled scan. Returns -ENOENT if
539  *	scheduled scan is not running. The caller may assume that as soon
540  *	as the call returns, it is safe to start a new scheduled scan again.
541  * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS: indicates that there are scheduled scan
542  *	results available.
543  * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED: indicates that the scheduled scan has
544  *	stopped.  The driver may issue this event at any time during a
545  *	scheduled scan.  One reason for stopping the scan is if the hardware
546  *	does not support starting an association or a normal scan while running
547  *	a scheduled scan.  This event is also sent when the
548  *	%NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN command is received or when the interface
549  *	is brought down while a scheduled scan was running.
550  *
551  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY: get survey results, e.g. channel occupation
552  *      or noise level
553  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS: survey data notification (as a reply to
554  *	NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY and on the "scan" multicast group)
555  *
556  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA: Add a PMKSA cache entry using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
557  *	(for the BSSID), %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and optionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK
558  *	(PMK is used for PTKSA derivation in case of FILS shared key offload) or
559  *	using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID,
560  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMK in case of FILS
561  *	authentication where %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the identifier
562  *	advertised by a FILS capable AP identifying the scope of PMKSA in an
563  *	ESS.
564  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA: Delete a PMKSA cache entry, using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
565  *	(for the BSSID) and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID or using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
566  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID in case of FILS
567  *	authentication. Additionally in case of SAE offload and OWE offloads
568  *	PMKSA entry can be deleted using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID.
569  * @NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA: Flush all PMKSA cache entries.
570  *
571  * @NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE: indicates to userspace the regulatory domain
572  *	has been changed and provides details of the request information
573  *	that caused the change such as who initiated the regulatory request
574  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR), the wiphy_idx
575  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2) on which the request was made from if
576  *	the initiator was %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE or
577  *	%NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER, the type of regulatory domain
578  *	set (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE), if the type of regulatory domain is
579  *	%NL80211_REG_TYPE_COUNTRY the alpha2 to which we have moved on
580  *	to (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2).
581  * @NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT: indicates to userspace that an AP beacon
582  *	has been found while world roaming thus enabling active scan or
583  *	any mode of operation that initiates TX (beacons) on a channel
584  *	where we would not have been able to do either before. As an example
585  *	if you are world roaming (regulatory domain set to world or if your
586  *	driver is using a custom world roaming regulatory domain) and while
587  *	doing a passive scan on the 5 GHz band you find an AP there (if not
588  *	on a DFS channel) you will now be able to actively scan for that AP
589  *	or use AP mode on your card on that same channel. Note that this will
590  *	never be used for channels 1-11 on the 2 GHz band as they are always
591  *	enabled world wide. This beacon hint is only sent if your device had
592  *	either disabled active scanning or beaconing on a channel. We send to
593  *	userspace the wiphy on which we removed a restriction from
594  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY) and the channel on which this occurred
595  *	before (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE) and after (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER)
596  *	the beacon hint was processed.
597  *
598  * @NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE: authentication request and notification.
599  *	This command is used both as a command (request to authenticate) and
600  *	as an event on the "mlme" multicast group indicating completion of the
601  *	authentication process.
602  *	When used as a command, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to identify the
603  *	interface. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify PeerSTAAddress (and
604  *	BSSID in case of station mode). %NL80211_ATTR_SSID is used to specify
605  *	the SSID (mainly for association, but is included in authentication
606  *	request, too, to help BSS selection. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ +
607  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET is used to specify the frequency of the
608  *	channel in MHz. %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE is used to specify the
609  *	authentication type. %NL80211_ATTR_IE is used to define IEs
610  *	(VendorSpecificInfo, but also including RSN IE and FT IEs) to be added
611  *	to the frame.
612  *	When used as an event, this reports reception of an Authentication
613  *	frame in station and IBSS modes when the local MLME processed the
614  *	frame, i.e., it was for the local STA and was received in correct
615  *	state. This is similar to MLME-AUTHENTICATE.confirm primitive in the
616  *	MLME SAP interface (kernel providing MLME, userspace SME). The
617  *	included %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute contains the management frame
618  *	(including both the header and frame body, but not FCS). This event is
619  *	also used to indicate if the authentication attempt timed out. In that
620  *	case the %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute is replaced with a
621  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT flag (and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to indicate which
622  *	pending authentication timed out).
623  * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE: association request and notification; like
624  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Association and Reassociation
625  *	(similar to MLME-ASSOCIATE.request, MLME-REASSOCIATE.request,
626  *	MLME-ASSOCIATE.confirm or MLME-REASSOCIATE.confirm primitives). The
627  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID attribute is used to specify whether the
628  *	request is for the initial association to an ESS (that attribute not
629  *	included) or for reassociation within the ESS (that attribute is
630  *	included).
631  * @NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE: deauthentication request and notification; like
632  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Deauthentication frames (similar to
633  *	MLME-DEAUTHENTICATION.request and MLME-DEAUTHENTICATE.indication
634  *	primitives).
635  * @NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE: disassociation request and notification; like
636  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Disassociation frames (similar to
637  *	MLME-DISASSOCIATE.request and MLME-DISASSOCIATE.indication primitives).
638  *
639  * @NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE: notification of a locally detected Michael
640  *	MIC (part of TKIP) failure; sent on the "mlme" multicast group; the
641  *	event includes %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to describe the source MAC address of
642  *	the frame with invalid MIC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE to show the key
643  *	type, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX to indicate the key identifier, and
644  *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ to indicate the TSC value of the frame; this
645  *	event matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication() primitive
646  *
647  * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS: Join a new IBSS -- given at least an SSID and a
648  *	FREQ attribute (for the initial frequency if no peer can be found)
649  *	and optionally a MAC (as BSSID) and FREQ_FIXED attribute if those
650  *	should be fixed rather than automatically determined. Can only be
651  *	executed on a network interface that is UP, and fixed BSSID/FREQ
652  *	may be rejected. Another optional parameter is the beacon interval,
653  *	given in the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL attribute, which if not
654  *	given defaults to 100 TU (102.4ms).
655  * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS: Leave the IBSS -- no special arguments, the IBSS is
656  *	determined by the network interface.
657  *
658  * @NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE: testmode command, takes a wiphy (or ifindex) attribute
659  *	to identify the device, and the TESTDATA blob attribute to pass through
660  *	to the driver.
661  *
662  * @NL80211_CMD_CONNECT: connection request and notification; this command
663  *	requests to connect to a specified network but without separating
664  *	auth and assoc steps. For this, you need to specify the SSID in a
665  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute, and can optionally specify the association
666  *	IEs in %NL80211_ATTR_IE, %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE,
667  *	%NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
668  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT,
669  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
670  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT,
671  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT, and
672  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT.
673  *	If included, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ are
674  *	restrictions on BSS selection, i.e., they effectively prevent roaming
675  *	within the ESS. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT
676  *	can be included to provide a recommendation of the initial BSS while
677  *	allowing the driver to roam to other BSSes within the ESS and also to
678  *	ignore this recommendation if the indicated BSS is not ideal. Only one
679  *	set of BSSID,frequency parameters is used (i.e., either the enforcing
680  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC,%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ or the less strict
681  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT).
682  *	Driver shall not modify the IEs specified through %NL80211_ATTR_IE if
683  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC is included. However, if %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT is
684  *	included, these IEs through %NL80211_ATTR_IE are specified by the user
685  *	space based on the best possible BSS selected. Thus, if the driver ends
686  *	up selecting a different BSS, it can modify these IEs accordingly (e.g.
687  *	userspace asks the driver to perform PMKSA caching with BSS1 and the
688  *	driver ends up selecting BSS2 with different PMKSA cache entry; RSNIE
689  *	has to get updated with the apt PMKID).
690  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID can be used to request a reassociation within
691  *	the ESS in case the device is already associated and an association with
692  *	a different BSS is desired.
693  *	Background scan period can optionally be
694  *	specified in %NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD,
695  *	if not specified default background scan configuration
696  *	in driver is used and if period value is 0, bg scan will be disabled.
697  *	This attribute is ignored if driver does not support roam scan.
698  *	It is also sent as an event, with the BSSID and response IEs when the
699  *	connection is established or failed to be established. This can be
700  *	determined by the %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute (0 = success,
701  *	non-zero = failure). If %NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT is included in the
702  *	event, the connection attempt failed due to not being able to initiate
703  *	authentication/association or not receiving a response from the AP.
704  *	Non-zero %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE value is indicated in that case as
705  *	well to remain backwards compatible.
706  * @NL80211_CMD_ROAM: Notification indicating the card/driver roamed by itself.
707  *	When a security association was established on an 802.1X network using
708  *	fast transition, this event should be followed by an
709  *	%NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED event.
710  *	Following a %NL80211_CMD_ROAM event userspace can issue
711  *	%NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN in order to obtain the scan information for the
712  *	new BSS the card/driver roamed to.
713  * @NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT: drop a given connection; also used to notify
714  *	userspace that a connection was dropped by the AP or due to other
715  *	reasons, for this the %NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP and
716  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE attributes are used.
717  *
718  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS: Set a wiphy's netns. Note that all devices
719  *	associated with this wiphy must be down and will follow.
720  *
721  * @NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Request to remain awake on the specified
722  *	channel for the specified amount of time. This can be used to do
723  *	off-channel operations like transmit a Public Action frame and wait for
724  *	a response while being associated to an AP on another channel.
725  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify which interface (and thus
726  *	radio) is used. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used to specify the
727  *	frequency for the operation.
728  *	%NL80211_ATTR_DURATION is used to specify the duration in milliseconds
729  *	to remain on the channel. This command is also used as an event to
730  *	notify when the requested duration starts (it may take a while for the
731  *	driver to schedule this time due to other concurrent needs for the
732  *	radio).
733  *	When called, this operation returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE)
734  *	that will be included with any events pertaining to this request;
735  *	the cookie is also used to cancel the request.
736  * @NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: This command can be used to cancel a
737  *	pending remain-on-channel duration if the desired operation has been
738  *	completed prior to expiration of the originally requested duration.
739  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the
740  *	radio. The %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attribute must be given as well to
741  *	uniquely identify the request.
742  *	This command is also used as an event to notify when a requested
743  *	remain-on-channel duration has expired.
744  *
745  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK: Set the mask of rates to be used in TX
746  *	rate selection. %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the interface
747  *	and @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES the set of allowed rates.
748  *
749  * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME: Register for receiving certain mgmt frames
750  *	(via @NL80211_CMD_FRAME) for processing in userspace. This command
751  *	requires an interface index, a frame type attribute (optional for
752  *	backward compatibility reasons, if not given assumes action frames)
753  *	and a match attribute containing the first few bytes of the frame
754  *	that should match, e.g. a single byte for only a category match or
755  *	four bytes for vendor frames including the OUI. The registration
756  *	cannot be dropped, but is removed automatically when the netlink
757  *	socket is closed. Multiple registrations can be made.
758  *	The %NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST flag attribute can be given if
759  *	%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS is available, in which
760  *	case the registration can also be modified to include/exclude the
761  *	flag, rather than requiring unregistration to change it.
762  * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME for
763  *	backward compatibility
764  * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME: Management frame TX request and RX notification. This
765  *	command is used both as a request to transmit a management frame and
766  *	as an event indicating reception of a frame that was not processed in
767  *	kernel code, but is for us (i.e., which may need to be processed in a
768  *	user space application). %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the
769  *	frame contents (including header). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used
770  *	to indicate on which channel the frame is to be transmitted or was
771  *	received. If this channel is not the current channel (remain-on-channel
772  *	or the operational channel) the device will switch to the given channel
773  *	and transmit the frame, optionally waiting for a response for the time
774  *	specified using %NL80211_ATTR_DURATION. When called, this operation
775  *	returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE) that will be included with the
776  *	TX status event pertaining to the TX request.
777  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the
778  *	management frames at CCK rate or not in 2GHz band.
779  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX is an array of offsets to CSA
780  *	counters which will be updated to the current value. This attribute
781  *	is used during CSA period.
782  *	For TX on an MLD, the frequency can be omitted and the link ID be
783  *	specified, or if transmitting to a known peer MLD (with MLD addresses
784  *	in the frame) both can be omitted and the link will be selected by
785  *	lower layers.
786  *	For RX notification, %NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to
787  *	indicate the frame RX timestamp and %NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP may
788  *	be included to indicate the ack TX timestamp.
789  * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL: When an off-channel TX was requested, this
790  *	command may be used with the corresponding cookie to cancel the wait
791  *	time if it is known that it is no longer necessary.  This command is
792  *	also sent as an event whenever the driver has completed the off-channel
793  *	wait time.
794  * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME for backward compatibility.
795  * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a management frame
796  *	transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME. %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies
797  *	the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME includes the contents of the
798  *	frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included if the recipient acknowledged
799  *	the frame. %NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to indicate the
800  *	tx timestamp and %NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to
801  *	indicate the ack RX timestamp.
802  * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS for
803  *	backward compatibility.
804  *
805  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE: Set powersave, using %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE
806  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE: Get powersave status in %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE
807  *
808  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM: Connection quality monitor configuration. This command
809  *	is used to configure connection quality monitoring notification trigger
810  *	levels.
811  * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM: Connection quality monitor notification. This
812  *	command is used as an event to indicate the that a trigger level was
813  *	reached.
814  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL: Set the channel (using %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
815  *	and the attributes determining channel width) the given interface
816  *	(identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX) shall operate on.
817  *	In case multiple channels are supported by the device, the mechanism
818  *	with which it switches channels is implementation-defined.
819  *	When a monitor interface is given, it can only switch channel while
820  *	no other interfaces are operating to avoid disturbing the operation
821  *	of any other interfaces, and other interfaces will again take
822  *	precedence when they are used.
823  *
824  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER: Set the MAC address of the peer on a WDS interface
825  *	(no longer supported).
826  *
827  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST: Configure if this AP should perform
828  *	multicast to unicast conversion. When enabled, all multicast packets
829  *	with ethertype ARP, IPv4 or IPv6 (possibly within an 802.1Q header)
830  *	will be sent out to each station once with the destination (multicast)
831  *	MAC address replaced by the station's MAC address. Note that this may
832  *	break certain expectations of the receiver, e.g. the ability to drop
833  *	unicast IP packets encapsulated in multicast L2 frames, or the ability
834  *	to not send destination unreachable messages in such cases.
835  *	This can only be toggled per BSS. Configure this on an interface of
836  *	type %NL80211_IFTYPE_AP. It applies to all its VLAN interfaces
837  *	(%NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN), except for those in 4addr (WDS) mode.
838  *	If %NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED is not present with this
839  *	command, the feature is disabled.
840  *
841  * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH: Join a mesh. The mesh ID must be given, and initial
842  *	mesh config parameters may be given.
843  * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH: Leave the mesh network -- no special arguments, the
844  *	network is determined by the network interface.
845  *
846  * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE: Unprotected deauthentication frame
847  *	notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected
848  *	deauthentication frame was dropped when MFP is in use.
849  * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE: Unprotected disassociation frame
850  *	notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected
851  *	disassociation frame was dropped when MFP is in use.
852  *
853  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE: Notification on the reception of a
854  *      beacon or probe response from a compatible mesh peer.  This is only
855  *      sent while no station information (sta_info) exists for the new peer
856  *      candidate and when @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH,
857  *      @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE, or
858  *      @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM is set.  On reception of this
859  *      notification, userspace may decide to create a new station
860  *      (@NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION).  To stop this notification from
861  *      reoccurring, the userspace authentication daemon may want to create the
862  *      new station with the AUTHENTICATED flag unset and maybe change it later
863  *      depending on the authentication result.
864  *
865  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN: get Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings.
866  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN: set Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings.
867  *	Since wireless is more complex than wired ethernet, it supports
868  *	various triggers. These triggers can be configured through this
869  *	command with the %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute. For
870  *	more background information, see
871  *	https://wireless.wiki.kernel.org/en/users/Documentation/WoWLAN.
872  *	The @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN command can also be used as a notification
873  *	from the driver reporting the wakeup reason. In this case, the
874  *	@NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute will contain the reason
875  *	for the wakeup, if it was caused by wireless. If it is not present
876  *	in the wakeup notification, the wireless device didn't cause the
877  *	wakeup but reports that it was woken up.
878  *
879  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD: This command is used give the driver
880  *	the necessary information for supporting GTK rekey offload. This
881  *	feature is typically used during WoWLAN. The configuration data
882  *	is contained in %NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA (which is nested and
883  *	contains the data in sub-attributes). After rekeying happened,
884  *	this command may also be sent by the driver as an MLME event to
885  *	inform userspace of the new replay counter.
886  *
887  * @NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: This is used as an event to inform userspace
888  *	of PMKSA caching candidates.
889  *
890  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER: Perform a high-level TDLS command (e.g. link setup).
891  *	In addition, this can be used as an event to request userspace to take
892  *	actions on TDLS links (set up a new link or tear down an existing one).
893  *	In such events, %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION indicates the requested
894  *	operation, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC contains the peer MAC address, and
895  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE the reason code to be used (only with
896  *	%NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN).
897  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT: Send a TDLS management frame. The
898  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION attribute determines the type of frame to be
899  *	sent. Public Action codes (802.11-2012 8.1.5.1) will be sent as
900  *	802.11 management frames, while TDLS action codes (802.11-2012
901  *	8.5.13.1) will be encapsulated and sent as data frames. The currently
902  *	supported Public Action code is %WLAN_PUB_ACTION_TDLS_DISCOVER_RES
903  *	and the currently supported TDLS actions codes are given in
904  *	&enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode.
905  *
906  * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME: Used by an application controlling an AP
907  *	(or GO) interface (i.e. hostapd) to ask for unexpected frames to
908  *	implement sending deauth to stations that send unexpected class 3
909  *	frames. Also used as the event sent by the kernel when such a frame
910  *	is received.
911  *	For the event, the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC attribute carries the TA and
912  *	other attributes like the interface index are present.
913  *	If used as the command it must have an interface index and you can
914  *	only unsubscribe from the event by closing the socket. Subscription
915  *	is also for %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME events.
916  *
917  * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME: Sent as an event indicating that the
918  *	associated station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC sent a 4addr frame
919  *	and wasn't already in a 4-addr VLAN. The event will be sent similarly
920  *	to the %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME event, to the same listener.
921  *
922  * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT: Probe an associated station on an AP interface
923  *	by sending a null data frame to it and reporting when the frame is
924  *	acknowledged. This is used to allow timing out inactive clients. Uses
925  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. The command returns a
926  *	direct reply with an %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE that is later used to match
927  *	up the event with the request. The event includes the same data and
928  *	has %NL80211_ATTR_ACK set if the frame was ACKed.
929  *
930  * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS: Register this socket to receive beacons from
931  *	other BSSes when any interfaces are in AP mode. This helps implement
932  *	OLBC handling in hostapd. Beacons are reported in %NL80211_CMD_FRAME
933  *	messages. Note that per PHY only one application may register.
934  *
935  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP: sets a bitmap for the individual TIDs whether
936  *      No Acknowledgement Policy should be applied.
937  *
938  * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY: An AP or GO may decide to switch channels
939  *	independently of the userspace SME, send this event indicating
940  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is now on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the
941  *	attributes determining channel width.  This indication may also be
942  *	sent when a remotely-initiated switch (e.g., when a STA receives a CSA
943  *	from the remote AP) is completed;
944  *
945  * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY: Notify that a channel switch
946  *	has been started on an interface, regardless of the initiator
947  *	(ie. whether it was requested from a remote device or
948  *	initiated on our own).  It indicates that
949  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX will be on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
950  *	after %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT TBTT's.  The userspace may
951  *	decide to react to this indication by requesting other
952  *	interfaces to change channel as well.
953  *
954  * @NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE: Start the given P2P Device, identified by
955  *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier. It must have been created with
956  *	%NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE previously. After it has been started, the
957  *	P2P Device can be used for P2P operations, e.g. remain-on-channel and
958  *	public action frame TX.
959  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE: Stop the given P2P Device, identified by
960  *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier.
961  *
962  * @NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED: connection request to an AP failed; used to
963  *	notify userspace that AP has rejected the connection request from a
964  *	station, due to particular reason. %NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON
965  *	is used for this.
966  *
967  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE: Change the rate used to send multicast frames
968  *	for IBSS or MESH vif.
969  *
970  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL: sets ACL for MAC address based access control.
971  *	This is to be used with the drivers advertising the support of MAC
972  *	address based access control. List of MAC addresses is passed in
973  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS and ACL policy is passed in
974  *	%NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY. Driver will enable ACL with this list, if it
975  *	is not already done. The new list will replace any existing list. Driver
976  *	will clear its ACL when the list of MAC addresses passed is empty. This
977  *	command is used in AP/P2P GO mode. Driver has to make sure to clear its
978  *	ACL list during %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP.
979  *
980  * @NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT: Start a Channel availability check (CAC). Once
981  *	a radar is detected or the channel availability scan (CAC) has finished
982  *	or was aborted, or a radar was detected, usermode will be notified with
983  *	this event. This command is also used to notify userspace about radars
984  *	while operating on this channel.
985  *	%NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT is used to inform about the type of the
986  *	event.
987  *
988  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: Get global nl80211 protocol features,
989  *	i.e. features for the nl80211 protocol rather than device features.
990  *	Returns the features in the %NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES bitmap.
991  *
992  * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES: Pass down the most up-to-date Fast Transition
993  *	Information Element to the WLAN driver
994  *
995  * @NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT: Send a Fast transition event from the WLAN driver
996  *	to the supplicant. This will carry the target AP's MAC address along
997  *	with the relevant Information Elements. This event is used to report
998  *	received FT IEs (MDIE, FTIE, RSN IE, TIE, RICIE).
999  *
1000  * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START: Indicates user-space will start running
1001  *	a critical protocol that needs more reliability in the connection to
1002  *	complete.
1003  *
1004  * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP: Indicates the connection reliability can
1005  *	return back to normal.
1006  *
1007  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE: Get currently supported coalesce rules.
1008  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE: Configure coalesce rules or clear existing rules.
1009  *
1010  * @NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Perform a channel switch by announcing the
1011  *	new channel information (Channel Switch Announcement - CSA)
1012  *	in the beacon for some time (as defined in the
1013  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT parameter) and then change to the
1014  *	new channel. Userspace provides the new channel information (using
1015  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the attributes determining channel
1016  *	width). %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX may be supplied to inform
1017  *	other station that transmission must be blocked until the channel
1018  *	switch is complete.
1019  *
1020  * @NL80211_CMD_VENDOR: Vendor-specified command/event. The command is specified
1021  *	by the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID attribute and a sub-command in
1022  *	%NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD. Parameter(s) can be transported in
1023  *	%NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
1024  *	For feature advertisement, the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute is
1025  *	used in the wiphy data as a nested attribute containing descriptions
1026  *	(&struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info) of the supported vendor commands.
1027  *	This may also be sent as an event with the same attributes.
1028  *
1029  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP: Set Interworking QoS mapping for IP DSCP values.
1030  *	The QoS mapping information is included in %NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP. If
1031  *	that attribute is not included, QoS mapping is disabled. Since this
1032  *	QoS mapping is relevant for IP packets, it is only valid during an
1033  *	association. This is cleared on disassociation and AP restart.
1034  *
1035  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS: Ask the kernel to add a traffic stream for the given
1036  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TSID and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC with %NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO
1037  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME parameters.
1038  *	Note that the action frame handshake with the AP shall be handled by
1039  *	userspace via the normal management RX/TX framework, this only sets
1040  *	up the TX TS in the driver/device.
1041  *	If the admitted time attribute is not added then the request just checks
1042  *	if a subsequent setup could be successful, the intent is to use this to
1043  *	avoid setting up a session with the AP when local restrictions would
1044  *	make that impossible. However, the subsequent "real" setup may still
1045  *	fail even if the check was successful.
1046  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS: Remove an existing TS with the %NL80211_ATTR_TSID
1047  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameters. It isn't necessary to call this
1048  *	before removing a station entry entirely, or before disassociating
1049  *	or similar, cleanup will happen in the driver/device in this case.
1050  *
1051  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP: Get mesh path attributes for mesh proxy path to
1052  *	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
1053  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
1054  *
1055  * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB: Join the OCB network. The center frequency and
1056  *	bandwidth of a channel must be given.
1057  * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB: Leave the OCB network -- no special arguments, the
1058  *	network is determined by the network interface.
1059  *
1060  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer,
1061  *	identified by the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameter. A target channel is
1062  *	provided via %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes determining
1063  *	channel width/type. The target operating class is given via
1064  *	%NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS.
1065  *	The driver is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching
1066  *	operations and returning to the base channel for communication with the
1067  *	AP.
1068  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS
1069  *	peer given by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. Both peers must be on the base channel
1070  *	when this command completes.
1071  *
1072  * @NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE: Similar to %NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE, but used
1073  *	as an event to indicate changes for devices with wiphy-specific regdom
1074  *	management.
1075  *
1076  * @NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN: Stop an ongoing scan. Returns -ENOENT if a scan is
1077  *	not running. The driver indicates the status of the scan through
1078  *	cfg80211_scan_done().
1079  *
1080  * @NL80211_CMD_START_NAN: Start NAN operation, identified by its
1081  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface. This interface must have been
1082  *	previously created with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE. After it
1083  *	has been started, the NAN interface will create or join a
1084  *	cluster. This command must have a valid
1085  *	%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF attribute and optional
1086  *	%NL80211_ATTR_BANDS attributes.  If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is
1087  *	omitted or set to 0, it means don't-care and the device will
1088  *	decide what to use.  After this command NAN functions can be
1089  *	added.
1090  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN: Stop the NAN operation, identified by
1091  *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface.
1092  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION: Add a NAN function. The function is defined
1093  *	with %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC nested attribute. When called, this
1094  *	operation returns the strictly positive and unique instance id
1095  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID) and a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE)
1096  *	of the function upon success.
1097  *	Since instance ID's can be re-used, this cookie is the right
1098  *	way to identify the function. This will avoid races when a termination
1099  *	event is handled by the user space after it has already added a new
1100  *	function that got the same instance id from the kernel as the one
1101  *	which just terminated.
1102  *	This cookie may be used in NAN events even before the command
1103  *	returns, so userspace shouldn't process NAN events until it processes
1104  *	the response to this command.
1105  *	Look at %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER as well.
1106  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION: Delete a NAN function by cookie.
1107  *	This command is also used as a notification sent when a NAN function is
1108  *	terminated. This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID
1109  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attributes.
1110  * @NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG: Change current NAN
1111  *	configuration. NAN must be operational (%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN
1112  *	was executed).  It must contain at least one of the following
1113  *	attributes: %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF,
1114  *	%NL80211_ATTR_BANDS.  If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is omitted, the
1115  *	current configuration is not changed.  If it is present but
1116  *	set to zero, the configuration is changed to don't-care
1117  *	(i.e. the device can decide what to do).
1118  * @NL80211_CMD_NAN_MATCH: Notification sent when a match is reported.
1119  *	This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH nested attribute and
1120  *	%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE.
1121  *
1122  * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS: Update one or more connect parameters
1123  *	for subsequent roaming cases if the driver or firmware uses internal
1124  *	BSS selection. This command can be issued only while connected and it
1125  *	does not result in a change for the current association. Currently,
1126  *	only the %NL80211_ATTR_IE data is used and updated with this command.
1127  *
1128  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, set the PMK or PMK-R0
1129  *	for the given authenticator address (specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MAC).
1130  *	When %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME is set, %NL80211_ATTR_PMK specifies the
1131  *	PMK-R0, otherwise it specifies the PMK.
1132  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, delete the previously
1133  *	configured PMK for the authenticator address identified by
1134  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
1135  * @NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED: An event that indicates port is authorized and
1136  *	open for regular data traffic. For STA/P2P-client, this event is sent
1137  *	with AP MAC address and for AP/P2P-GO, the event carries the STA/P2P-
1138  *	client MAC address.
1139  *	Drivers that support 4 way handshake offload should send this event for
1140  *	STA/P2P-client after successful 4-way HS or after 802.1X FT following
1141  *	NL80211_CMD_CONNECT or NL80211_CMD_ROAM. Drivers using AP/P2P-GO 4-way
1142  *	handshake offload should send this event on successful completion of
1143  *	4-way handshake with the peer (STA/P2P-client).
1144  * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME: Control Port (e.g. PAE) frame TX request
1145  *	and RX notification.  This command is used both as a request to transmit
1146  *	a control port frame and as a notification that a control port frame
1147  *	has been received. %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the
1148  *	frame contents.  The frame is the raw EAPoL data, without ethernet or
1149  *	802.11 headers.
1150  *	For an MLD transmitter, the %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID may be given and
1151  *	its effect will depend on the destination: If the destination is known
1152  *	to be an MLD, this will be used as a hint to select the link to transmit
1153  *	the frame on. If the destination is not an MLD, this will select both
1154  *	the link to transmit on and the source address will be set to the link
1155  *	address of that link.
1156  *	When used as an event indication %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
1157  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC are added
1158  *	indicating the protocol type of the received frame; whether the frame
1159  *	was received unencrypted and the MAC address of the peer respectively.
1160  *
1161  * @NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB: Request that the regdb firmware file is reloaded.
1162  *
1163  * @NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH: This interface is exclusively defined for host
1164  *	drivers that do not define separate commands for authentication and
1165  *	association, but rely on user space for the authentication to happen.
1166  *	This interface acts both as the event request (driver to user space)
1167  *	to trigger the authentication and command response (userspace to
1168  *	driver) to indicate the authentication status.
1169  *
1170  *	User space uses the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT command to the host driver to
1171  *	trigger a connection. The host driver selects a BSS and further uses
1172  *	this interface to offload only the authentication part to the user
1173  *	space. Authentication frames are passed between the driver and user
1174  *	space through the %NL80211_CMD_FRAME interface. Host driver proceeds
1175  *	further with the association after getting successful authentication
1176  *	status. User space indicates the authentication status through
1177  *	%NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute in %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH
1178  *	command interface.
1179  *
1180  *	Host driver sends MLD address of the AP with %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR in
1181  *	%NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH event to indicate user space to enable MLO
1182  *	during the authentication offload in STA mode while connecting to MLD
1183  *	APs. Host driver should check %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT flag capability
1184  *	in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to know whether the user space supports enabling
1185  *	MLO during the authentication offload or not.
1186  *	User space should enable MLO during the authentication only when it
1187  *	receives the AP MLD address in authentication offload request. User
1188  *	space shouldn't enable MLO when the authentication offload request
1189  *	doesn't indicate the AP MLD address even if the AP is MLO capable.
1190  *	User space should use %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR as peer's MLD address and
1191  *	interface address identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX as self MLD
1192  *	address. User space and host driver to use MLD addresses in RA, TA and
1193  *	BSSID fields of the frames between them, and host driver translates the
1194  *	MLD addresses to/from link addresses based on the link chosen for the
1195  *	authentication.
1196  *
1197  *	Host driver reports this status on an authentication failure to the
1198  *	user space through the connect result as the user space would have
1199  *	initiated the connection through the connect request.
1200  *
1201  * @NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED: An event that notify station's
1202  *	ht opmode or vht opmode changes using any of %NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE,
1203  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,%NL80211_ATTR_NSS attributes with its
1204  *	address(specified in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC).
1205  *
1206  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, in
1207  *	the %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS attribute.
1208  *
1209  * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START: start a (set of) peer measurement(s)
1210  *	with the given parameters, which are encapsulated in the nested
1211  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS attribute. Optionally, MAC address
1212  *	randomization may be enabled and configured by specifying the
1213  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes.
1214  *	If a timeout is requested, use the %NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT attribute.
1215  *	A u64 cookie for further %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE use is returned in
1216  *	the netlink extended ack message.
1217  *
1218  *	To cancel a measurement, close the socket that requested it.
1219  *
1220  *	Measurement results are reported to the socket that requested the
1221  *	measurement using @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT when they
1222  *	become available, so applications must ensure a large enough socket
1223  *	buffer size.
1224  *
1225  *	Depending on driver support it may or may not be possible to start
1226  *	multiple concurrent measurements.
1227  * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT: This command number is used for the
1228  *	result notification from the driver to the requesting socket.
1229  * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE: Notification only, indicating that
1230  *	the measurement completed, using the measurement cookie
1231  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE).
1232  *
1233  * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR: Notify the kernel that a radar signal was
1234  *	detected and reported by a neighboring device on the channel
1235  *	indicated by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes
1236  *	determining the width and type.
1237  *
1238  * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO: This interface allows the host driver to
1239  *	offload OWE processing to user space. This intends to support
1240  *	OWE AKM by the host drivers that implement SME but rely
1241  *	on the user space for the cryptographic/DH IE processing in AP mode.
1242  *
1243  * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK: The requirement for mesh link metric
1244  *	refreshing, is that from one mesh point we be able to send some data
1245  *	frames to other mesh points which are not currently selected as a
1246  *	primary traffic path, but which are only 1 hop away. The absence of
1247  *	the primary path to the chosen node makes it necessary to apply some
1248  *	form of marking on a chosen packet stream so that the packets can be
1249  *	properly steered to the selected node for testing, and not by the
1250  *	regular mesh path lookup. Further, the packets must be of type data
1251  *	so that the rate control (often embedded in firmware) is used for
1252  *	rate selection.
1253  *
1254  *	Here attribute %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify connected mesh
1255  *	peer MAC address and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the frame
1256  *	content. The frame is ethernet data.
1257  *
1258  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG: Data frame TID specific configuration
1259  *	is passed using %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG attribute.
1260  *
1261  * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_BEACON: Unprotected or incorrectly protected Beacon
1262  *	frame. This event is used to indicate that a received Beacon frame was
1263  *	dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while beacon
1264  *	protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode).
1265  *
1266  * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a control
1267  *	port frame transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME.
1268  *	%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME
1269  *	includes the contents of the frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included
1270  *	if the recipient acknowledged the frame.
1271  *
1272  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS: SAR power limitation configuration is
1273  *	passed using %NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is used to
1274  *	specify the wiphy index to be applied to.
1275  *
1276  * @NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION: This notification is sent out whenever
1277  *	mac80211/drv detects a bss color collision.
1278  *
1279  * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_REQUEST: This command is used to indicate that
1280  *	userspace wants to change the BSS color.
1281  *
1282  * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED: Notify userland, that a color change has
1283  *	started
1284  *
1285  * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED: Notify userland, that the color change has
1286  *	been aborted
1287  *
1288  * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED: Notify userland that the color change
1289  *	has completed
1290  *
1291  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD: Set FILS AAD data to the driver using -
1292  *	&NL80211_ATTR_MAC - for STA MAC address
1293  *	&NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - for KEK
1294  *	&NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES - for FILS Nonces
1295  *		(STA Nonce 16 bytes followed by AP Nonce 16 bytes)
1296  *
1297  * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_COMEBACK: notification about an association
1298  *      temporal rejection with comeback. The event includes %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
1299  *      to describe the BSSID address of the AP and %NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT to
1300  *      specify the timeout value.
1301  *
1302  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK: Add a new link to an interface. The
1303  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID attribute is used for the new link.
1304  * @NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK: Remove a link from an interface. This may come
1305  *	without %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID as an easy way to remove all links
1306  *	in preparation for e.g. roaming to a regular (non-MLO) AP.
1307  *
1308  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK_STA: Add a link to an MLD station
1309  * @NL80211_CMD_MODIFY_LINK_STA: Modify a link of an MLD station
1310  * @NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK_STA: Remove a link of an MLD station
1311  *
1312  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP: Enable/disable HW timestamping of Timing
1313  *	measurement and Fine timing measurement frames. If %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
1314  *	is included, enable/disable HW timestamping only for frames to/from the
1315  *	specified MAC address. Otherwise enable/disable HW timestamping for
1316  *	all TM/FTM frames (including ones that were enabled with specific MAC
1317  *	address). If %NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED is not included, disable
1318  *	HW timestamping.
1319  *	The number of peers that HW timestamping can be enabled for concurrently
1320  *	is indicated by %NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS.
1321  *
1322  * @NL80211_CMD_LINKS_REMOVED: Notify userspace about the removal of STA MLD
1323  *	setup links due to AP MLD removing the corresponding affiliated APs with
1324  *	Multi-Link reconfiguration. %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS is used to provide
1325  *	information about the removed STA MLD setup links.
1326  *
1327  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_TO_LINK_MAPPING: Set the TID to Link Mapping for a
1328  *      non-AP MLD station. The %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_DLINK and
1329  *      %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_ULINK attributes are used to specify the
1330  *      TID to Link mapping for downlink/uplink traffic.
1331  *
1332  * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_MLO_RECONF: For a non-AP MLD station, request to
1333  *      add/remove links to/from the association. To indicate link
1334  *      reconfiguration request results from the driver, this command is also
1335  *      used as an event to notify userspace about the added links information.
1336  *      For notifying the removed links information, the existing
1337  *      %NL80211_CMD_LINKS_REMOVED command is used. This command is also used to
1338  *      notify userspace about newly added links for the current connection in
1339  *      case of AP-initiated link recommendation requests, received via
1340  *      a BTM (BSS Transition Management) request or a link reconfig notify
1341  *      frame, where the driver handles the link recommendation offload.
1342  *
1343  * @NL80211_CMD_EPCS_CFG: EPCS configuration for a station. Used by userland to
1344  *	control EPCS configuration. Used to notify userland on the current state
1345  *	of EPCS.
1346  *
1347  * @NL80211_CMD_MAX: highest used command number
1348  * @__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST: internal use
1349  */
1350 enum nl80211_commands {
1351 /* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */
1352 	NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC,
1353 
1354 	NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY,		/* can dump */
1355 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY,
1356 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY,
1357 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY,
1358 
1359 	NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE,	/* can dump */
1360 	NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE,
1361 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE,
1362 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE,
1363 
1364 	NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY,
1365 	NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY,
1366 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY,
1367 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY,
1368 
1369 	NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON,
1370 	NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON,
1371 	NL80211_CMD_START_AP,
1372 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_START_AP,
1373 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP,
1374 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP,
1375 
1376 	NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION,
1377 	NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION,
1378 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION,
1379 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION,
1380 
1381 	NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH,
1382 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH,
1383 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH,
1384 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH,
1385 
1386 	NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS,
1387 
1388 	NL80211_CMD_SET_REG,
1389 	NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG,
1390 
1391 	NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG,
1392 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG,
1393 
1394 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE /* reserved; not used */,
1395 
1396 	NL80211_CMD_GET_REG,
1397 
1398 	NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN,
1399 	NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN,
1400 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS,
1401 	NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED,
1402 
1403 	NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE,
1404 
1405 	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE,
1406 	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE,
1407 	NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1408 	NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE,
1409 
1410 	NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE,
1411 
1412 	NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT,
1413 
1414 	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS,
1415 	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS,
1416 
1417 	NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
1418 
1419 	NL80211_CMD_CONNECT,
1420 	NL80211_CMD_ROAM,
1421 	NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT,
1422 
1423 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS,
1424 
1425 	NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY,
1426 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS,
1427 
1428 	NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA,
1429 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA,
1430 	NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA,
1431 
1432 	NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL,
1433 	NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL,
1434 
1435 	NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK,
1436 
1437 	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME,
1438 	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME,
1439 	NL80211_CMD_FRAME,
1440 	NL80211_CMD_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_FRAME,
1441 	NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1442 	NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS = NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1443 
1444 	NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE,
1445 	NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE,
1446 
1447 	NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM,
1448 	NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM,
1449 
1450 	NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL,
1451 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER,
1452 
1453 	NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL,
1454 
1455 	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH,
1456 	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH,
1457 
1458 	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1459 	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE,
1460 
1461 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE,
1462 
1463 	NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN,
1464 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN,
1465 
1466 	NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN,
1467 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN,
1468 	NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS,
1469 	NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED,
1470 
1471 	NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD,
1472 
1473 	NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
1474 
1475 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER,
1476 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT,
1477 
1478 	NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME,
1479 
1480 	NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT,
1481 
1482 	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS,
1483 
1484 	NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME,
1485 
1486 	NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP,
1487 
1488 	NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY,
1489 
1490 	NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE,
1491 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE,
1492 
1493 	NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED,
1494 
1495 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE,
1496 
1497 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL,
1498 
1499 	NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT,
1500 
1501 	NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES,
1502 
1503 	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES,
1504 	NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT,
1505 
1506 	NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START,
1507 	NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP,
1508 
1509 	NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE,
1510 	NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE,
1511 
1512 	NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1513 
1514 	NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
1515 
1516 	NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP,
1517 
1518 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS,
1519 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS,
1520 
1521 	NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP,
1522 
1523 	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB,
1524 	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB,
1525 
1526 	NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY,
1527 
1528 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1529 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1530 
1531 	NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE,
1532 
1533 	NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN,
1534 
1535 	NL80211_CMD_START_NAN,
1536 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN,
1537 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION,
1538 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION,
1539 	NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG,
1540 	NL80211_CMD_NAN_MATCH,
1541 
1542 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST,
1543 
1544 	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS,
1545 
1546 	NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK,
1547 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK,
1548 
1549 	NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED,
1550 
1551 	NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB,
1552 
1553 	NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH,
1554 
1555 	NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED,
1556 
1557 	NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME,
1558 
1559 	NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS,
1560 
1561 	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START,
1562 	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT,
1563 	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE,
1564 
1565 	NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR,
1566 
1567 	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO,
1568 
1569 	NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK,
1570 
1571 	NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG,
1572 
1573 	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_BEACON,
1574 
1575 	NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1576 
1577 	NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS,
1578 
1579 	NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION,
1580 
1581 	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_REQUEST,
1582 
1583 	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED,
1584 	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED,
1585 	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED,
1586 
1587 	NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD,
1588 
1589 	NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_COMEBACK,
1590 
1591 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK,
1592 	NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK,
1593 
1594 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK_STA,
1595 	NL80211_CMD_MODIFY_LINK_STA,
1596 	NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK_STA,
1597 
1598 	NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP,
1599 
1600 	NL80211_CMD_LINKS_REMOVED,
1601 
1602 	NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_TO_LINK_MAPPING,
1603 
1604 	NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_MLO_RECONF,
1605 	NL80211_CMD_EPCS_CFG,
1606 
1607 	/* add new commands above here */
1608 
1609 	/* used to define NL80211_CMD_MAX below */
1610 	__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST,
1611 	NL80211_CMD_MAX = __NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST - 1
1612 };
1613 
1614 /*
1615  * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new commands by defining them
1616  * here
1617  */
1618 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS
1619 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE
1620 #define NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE
1621 #define NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE
1622 #define NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE
1623 #define NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE
1624 #define NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE
1625 #define NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT
1626 
1627 #define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS
1628 
1629 /* source-level API compatibility */
1630 #define NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG
1631 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG
1632 #define NL80211_MESH_SETUP_VENDOR_PATH_SEL_IE NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE
1633 
1634 /**
1635  * enum nl80211_attrs - nl80211 netlink attributes
1636  *
1637  * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC: unspecified attribute to catch errors
1638  *
1639  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY: index of wiphy to operate on, cf.
1640  *	/sys/class/ieee80211/<phyname>/index
1641  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME: wiphy name (used for renaming)
1642  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS: a nested array of TX queue parameters
1643  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ: frequency of the selected channel in MHz,
1644  *	defines the channel together with the (deprecated)
1645  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE attribute or the attributes
1646  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH and if needed %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
1647  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2
1648  * @NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH: u32 attribute containing one of the values
1649  *	of &enum nl80211_chan_width, describing the channel width. See the
1650  *	documentation of the enum for more information.
1651  * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1: Center frequency of the first part of the
1652  *	channel, used for anything but 20 MHz bandwidth. In S1G this is the
1653  *	operating channel center frequency.
1654  * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2: Center frequency of the second part of the
1655  *	channel, used only for 80+80 MHz bandwidth
1656  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE: included with NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
1657  *	if HT20 or HT40 are to be used (i.e., HT disabled if not included):
1658  *	NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT = HT not allowed (i.e., same as not including
1659  *		this attribute)
1660  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT20 = HT20 only
1661  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS = secondary channel is below the primary channel
1662  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS = secondary channel is above the primary channel
1663  *	This attribute is now deprecated.
1664  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT: TX retry limit for frames whose length is
1665  *	less than or equal to the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255;
1666  *	dot11ShortRetryLimit; u8
1667  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG: TX retry limit for frames whose length is
1668  *	greater than the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255;
1669  *	dot11ShortLongLimit; u8
1670  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD: fragmentation threshold, i.e., maximum
1671  *	length in octets for frames; allowed range: 256..8000, disable
1672  *	fragmentation with (u32)-1; dot11FragmentationThreshold; u32
1673  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD: RTS threshold (TX frames with length
1674  *	larger than or equal to this use RTS/CTS handshake); allowed range:
1675  *	0..65536, disable with (u32)-1; dot11RTSThreshold; u32
1676  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS: Coverage Class as defined by IEEE 802.11
1677  *	section 7.3.2.9; dot11CoverageClass; u8
1678  *
1679  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX: network interface index of the device to operate on
1680  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME: network interface name
1681  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE: type of virtual interface, see &enum nl80211_iftype
1682  *
1683  * @NL80211_ATTR_WDEV: wireless device identifier, used for pseudo-devices
1684  *	that don't have a netdev (u64)
1685  *
1686  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC: MAC address (various uses)
1687  *
1688  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of
1689  *	16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC
1690  *	keys
1691  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3)
1692  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11
1693  *	section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04)
1694  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and
1695  *	CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian
1696  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT: Flag attribute indicating the key is default key
1697  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: Flag attribute indicating the key is the
1698  *	default management key
1699  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE: For crypto settings for connect or
1700  *	other commands, indicates which pairwise cipher suites are used
1701  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP: For crypto settings for connect or
1702  *	other commands, indicates which group cipher suite is used
1703  *
1704  * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval in TU
1705  * @NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing
1706  * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD: portion of the beacon before the TIM IE
1707  * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL: portion of the beacon after the TIM IE
1708  *
1709  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID: Association ID for the station (u16)
1710  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of
1711  *	&enum nl80211_sta_flags (deprecated, use %NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2)
1712  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL: listen interval as defined by
1713  *	IEEE 802.11 7.3.1.6 (u16).
1714  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES: supported rates, array of supported
1715  *	rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length
1716  *	restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
1717  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN: interface index of VLAN interface to move station
1718  *	to, or the AP interface the station was originally added to.
1719  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO: information about a station, part of station info
1720  *	given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION, nested attribute containing
1721  *	info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_info.
1722  *
1723  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS: Information about an operating bands,
1724  *	consisting of a nested array.
1725  *
1726  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID: mesh id (1-32 bytes).
1727  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION: action to perform on the mesh peer link
1728  *	(see &enum nl80211_plink_action).
1729  * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP: MAC address of the next hop for a mesh path.
1730  * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO: information about a mesh_path, part of mesh path
1731  *	info given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH, nested attribute described at
1732  *	&enum nl80211_mpath_info.
1733  *
1734  * @NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of
1735  *      &enum nl80211_mntr_flags.
1736  *
1737  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2: an ISO-3166-alpha2 country code for which the
1738  *	current regulatory domain should be set to or is already set to.
1739  *	For example, 'CR', for Costa Rica. This attribute is used by the kernel
1740  *	to query the CRDA to retrieve one regulatory domain. This attribute can
1741  *	also be used by userspace to query the kernel for the currently set
1742  *	regulatory domain. We chose an alpha2 as that is also used by the
1743  *	IEEE-802.11 country information element to identify a country.
1744  *	Users can also simply ask the wireless core to set regulatory domain
1745  *	to a specific alpha2.
1746  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES: a nested array of regulatory domain regulatory
1747  *	rules.
1748  *
1749  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (u8, 0 or 1)
1750  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1751  *	(u8, 0 or 1)
1752  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time enabled
1753  *	(u8, 0 or 1)
1754  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES: basic rates, array of basic
1755  *	rates in format defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length
1756  *	restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
1757  *
1758  * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY: HT Capability information element (from
1759  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
1760  *
1761  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing all
1762  *	supported interface types, each a flag attribute with the number
1763  *	of the interface mode.
1764  *
1765  * @NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE: Management frame subtype for
1766  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE.
1767  *
1768  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE: Information element(s) data (used, e.g., with
1769  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE).
1770  *
1771  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can scan with
1772  *	a single scan request, a wiphy attribute.
1773  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can
1774  *	scan with a single scheduled scan request, a wiphy attribute.
1775  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information elements
1776  *	that can be added to a scan request
1777  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information
1778  *	elements that can be added to a scheduled scan request
1779  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS: maximum number of sets that can be
1780  *	used with @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH, a wiphy attribute.
1781  *
1782  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES: nested attribute with frequencies (in MHz)
1783  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS: nested attribute with SSIDs, leave out for passive
1784  *	scanning and include a zero-length SSID (wildcard) for wildcard scan
1785  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS: scan result BSS
1786  *
1787  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR: indicates who requested the regulatory domain
1788  *	currently in effect. This could be any of the %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_*
1789  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE: indicates the type of the regulatory domain currently
1790  *	set. This can be one of the nl80211_reg_type (%NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_*)
1791  *
1792  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS: wiphy attribute that specifies
1793  *	an array of command numbers (i.e. a mapping index to command number)
1794  *	that the driver for the given wiphy supports.
1795  *
1796  * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME: frame data (binary attribute), including frame header
1797  *	and body, but not FCS; used, e.g., with NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE and
1798  *	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE events
1799  * @NL80211_ATTR_SSID: SSID (binary attribute, 0..32 octets)
1800  * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE: AuthenticationType, see &enum nl80211_auth_type,
1801  *	represented as a u32
1802  * @NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE: ReasonCode for %NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE and
1803  *	%NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE, u16
1804  *
1805  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE: Key Type, see &enum nl80211_key_type, represented as
1806  *	a u32
1807  *
1808  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change
1809  *	due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects
1810  *	the state of the channel _before_ the beacon hint processing. This
1811  *	attributes consists of a nested attribute containing
1812  *	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_*
1813  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change
1814  *	due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects
1815  *	the state of the channel _after_ the beacon hint processing. This
1816  *	attributes consists of a nested attribute containing
1817  *	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_*
1818  *
1819  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES: a set of u32 values indicating the supported
1820  *	cipher suites
1821  *
1822  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED: a flag indicating the IBSS should not try to look
1823  *	for other networks on different channels
1824  *
1825  * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT: a flag indicating than an operation timed out; this
1826  *	is used, e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE event
1827  *
1828  * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP: Whether management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) is
1829  *	used for the association (&enum nl80211_mfp, represented as a u32);
1830  *	this attribute can be used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
1831  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests. %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL is not allowed for
1832  *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE since user space SME is expected and hence, it
1833  *	must have decided whether to use management frame protection or not.
1834  *	Setting %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL with a %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT request will
1835  *	let the driver (or the firmware) decide whether to use MFP or not.
1836  *
1837  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2: Attribute containing a
1838  *	&struct nl80211_sta_flag_update.
1839  *
1840  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT: A flag indicating whether user space controls
1841  *	IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED, in
1842  *	station mode. If the flag is included in %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE
1843  *	request, the driver will assume that the port is unauthorized until
1844  *	authorized by user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by
1845  *	default in station mode.
1846  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE: A 16-bit value indicating the
1847  *	ethertype that will be used for key negotiation. It can be
1848  *	specified with the associate and connect commands. If it is not
1849  *	specified, the value defaults to 0x888E (PAE, 802.1X). This
1850  *	attribute is also used as a flag in the wiphy information to
1851  *	indicate that protocols other than PAE are supported.
1852  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT: When included along with
1853  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE, indicates that the custom
1854  *	ethertype frames used for key negotiation must not be encrypted.
1855  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: A flag indicating whether control
1856  *	port frames (e.g. of type given in %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE)
1857  *	will be sent directly to the network interface or sent via the NL80211
1858  *	socket.  If this attribute is missing, then legacy behavior of sending
1859  *	control port frames directly to the network interface is used.  If the
1860  *	flag is included, then control port frames are sent over NL80211 instead
1861  *	using %CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME.  If control port routing over NL80211 is
1862  *	to be used then userspace must also use the %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER
1863  *	flag. When used with %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH, pre-auth
1864  *	frames are not forwarded over the control port.
1865  *
1866  * @NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA: Testmode data blob, passed through to the driver.
1867  *	We recommend using nested, driver-specific attributes within this.
1868  *
1869  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP: A flag indicating that the DISCONNECT
1870  *	event was due to the AP disconnecting the station, and not due to
1871  *	a local disconnect request.
1872  * @NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE: StatusCode for the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
1873  *	event (u16)
1874  * @NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY: Flag attribute, used with connect(), indicating
1875  *	that protected APs should be used. This is also used with NEW_BEACON to
1876  *	indicate that the BSS is to use protection.
1877  *
1878  * @NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1879  *	indicate which WPA version(s) the AP we want to associate with is using
1880  *	(a u32 with flags from &enum nl80211_wpa_versions).
1881  * @NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1882  *	indicate which key management algorithm(s) to use (an array of u32).
1883  *	This attribute is also sent in response to @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY,
1884  *	indicating the supported AKM suites, intended for specific drivers which
1885  *	implement SME and have constraints on which AKMs are supported and also
1886  *	the cases where an AKM support is offloaded to the driver/firmware.
1887  *	If there is no such notification from the driver, user space should
1888  *	assume the driver supports all the AKM suites.
1889  *
1890  * @NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE: (Re)association request information elements as
1891  *	sent out by the card, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events.
1892  * @NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE: (Re)association response information elements as
1893  *	sent by peer, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events.
1894  *
1895  * @NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID: previous BSSID, to be used in ASSOCIATE and CONNECT
1896  *	commands to specify a request to reassociate within an ESS, i.e., to use
1897  *	Reassociate Request frame (with the value of this attribute in the
1898  *	Current AP address field) instead of Association Request frame which is
1899  *	used for the initial association to an ESS.
1900  *
1901  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY: key information in a nested attribute with
1902  *	%NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes
1903  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEYS: array of keys for static WEP keys for connect()
1904  *	and join_ibss(), key information is in a nested attribute each
1905  *	with %NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes
1906  *
1907  * @NL80211_ATTR_PID: Process ID of a network namespace.
1908  * @NL80211_ATTR_NETNS_FD: File descriptor of a network namespace.
1909  *
1910  * @NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION: Used to indicate consistent snapshots for
1911  *	dumps. This number increases whenever the object list being
1912  *	dumped changes, and as such userspace can verify that it has
1913  *	obtained a complete and consistent snapshot by verifying that
1914  *	all dump messages contain the same generation number. If it
1915  *	changed then the list changed and the dump should be repeated
1916  *	completely from scratch.
1917  *
1918  * @NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR: Use 4-address frames on a virtual interface
1919  *
1920  * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO: survey information about a channel, part of
1921  *      the survey response for %NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY, nested attribute
1922  *      containing info as possible, see &enum survey_info.
1923  *
1924  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKID: PMK material for PMKSA caching.
1925  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS: maximum number of PMKIDs a firmware can
1926  *	cache, a wiphy attribute.
1927  *
1928  * @NL80211_ATTR_DURATION: Duration of an operation in milliseconds, u32.
1929  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION: Device attribute that
1930  *	specifies the maximum duration that can be requested with the
1931  *	remain-on-channel operation, in milliseconds, u32.
1932  *
1933  * @NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE: Generic 64-bit cookie to identify objects.
1934  *
1935  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES: Nested set of attributes
1936  *	(enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes) describing TX rates per band. The
1937  *	enum nl80211_band value is used as the index (nla_type() of the nested
1938  *	data. If a band is not included, it will be configured to allow all
1939  *	rates based on negotiated supported rates information. This attribute
1940  *	is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK and with starting AP,
1941  *	and joining mesh networks (not IBSS yet). In the later case, it must
1942  *	specify just a single bitrate, which is to be used for the beacon.
1943  *	The driver must also specify support for this with the extended
1944  *	features NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY,
1945  *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT,
1946  *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT and
1947  *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE.
1948  *
1949  * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH: A binary attribute which typically must contain
1950  *	at least one byte, currently used with @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME.
1951  * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE: A u16 indicating the frame type/subtype for the
1952  *	@NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command.
1953  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a
1954  *	nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing
1955  *	information about which frame types can be transmitted with
1956  *	%NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
1957  * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a
1958  *	nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing
1959  *	information about which frame types can be registered for RX.
1960  *
1961  * @NL80211_ATTR_ACK: Flag attribute indicating that the frame was
1962  *	acknowledged by the recipient.
1963  * @NL80211_ATTR_ACK_SIGNAL: Station's ack signal strength (s32)
1964  *
1965  * @NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE: powersave state, using &enum nl80211_ps_state values.
1966  *
1967  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM: connection quality monitor configuration in a
1968  *	nested attribute with %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_* sub-attributes.
1969  *
1970  * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE: Flag attribute to indicate that a command
1971  *	is requesting a local authentication/association state change without
1972  *	invoking actual management frame exchange. This can be used with
1973  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1974  *	NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE.
1975  *
1976  * @NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE: (AP mode) Do not forward traffic between stations
1977  *	connected to this BSS.
1978  *
1979  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type. See
1980  *      &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for possible values.
1981  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL: Transmit power level in signed mBm units.
1982  *      This is used in association with @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING
1983  *      for non-automatic settings.
1984  *
1985  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN, which mostly
1986  *	means support for per-station GTKs.
1987  *
1988  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for transmitting.
1989  *	This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should
1990  *	not be used for transmitting. If an antenna is not selected in this
1991  *	bitmap the hardware is not allowed to transmit on this antenna.
1992  *
1993  *	Each bit represents one antenna, starting with antenna 1 at the first
1994  *	bit. Depending on which antennas are selected in the bitmap, 802.11n
1995  *	drivers can derive which chainmasks to use (if all antennas belonging to
1996  *	a particular chain are disabled this chain should be disabled) and if
1997  *	a chain has diversity antennas whether diversity should be used or not.
1998  *	HT capabilities (STBC, TX Beamforming, Antenna selection) can be
1999  *	derived from the available chains after applying the antenna mask.
2000  *	Non-802.11n drivers can derive whether to use diversity or not.
2001  *	Drivers may reject configurations or RX/TX mask combinations they cannot
2002  *	support by returning -EINVAL.
2003  *
2004  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for receiving.
2005  *	This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should
2006  *	not be used for receiving. If an antenna is not selected in this bitmap
2007  *	the hardware should not be configured to receive on this antenna.
2008  *	For a more detailed description see @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX.
2009  *
2010  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX: Bitmap of antennas which are available
2011  *	for configuration as TX antennas via the above parameters.
2012  *
2013  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX: Bitmap of antennas which are available
2014  *	for configuration as RX antennas via the above parameters.
2015  *
2016  * @NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE: Multicast tx rate (in 100 kbps) for IBSS
2017  *
2018  * @NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK: For management frame TX, the frame may be
2019  *	transmitted on another channel when the channel given doesn't match
2020  *	the current channel. If the current channel doesn't match and this
2021  *	flag isn't set, the frame will be rejected. This is also used as an
2022  *	nl80211 capability flag.
2023  *
2024  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE: HT operation mode (u16)
2025  *
2026  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags
2027  *	attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as.
2028  *	See &enum nl80211_key_default_types.
2029  *
2030  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP: Optional mesh setup parameters.  These cannot be
2031  *	changed once the mesh is active.
2032  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG: Mesh configuration parameters, a nested attribute
2033  *	containing attributes from &enum nl80211_meshconf_params.
2034  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH: Currently, this means the underlying driver
2035  *	allows auth frames in a mesh to be passed to userspace for processing via
2036  *	the @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH flag.
2037  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE: The state of a mesh peer link as defined in
2038  *	&enum nl80211_plink_state. Used when userspace is driving the peer link
2039  *	management state machine.  @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE or
2040  *	@NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM must be enabled.
2041  *
2042  * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED: indicates, as part of the wiphy
2043  *	capabilities, the supported WoWLAN triggers
2044  * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS: used by %NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN to
2045  *	indicate which WoW triggers should be enabled. This is also
2046  *	used by %NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN to get the currently enabled WoWLAN
2047  *	triggers.
2048  *
2049  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL: Interval between scheduled scan
2050  *	cycles, in msecs.
2051  *
2052  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH: Nested attribute with one or more
2053  *	sets of attributes to match during scheduled scans.  Only BSSs
2054  *	that match any of the sets will be reported.  These are
2055  *	pass-thru filter rules.
2056  *	For a match to succeed, the BSS must match all attributes of a
2057  *	set.  Since not every hardware supports matching all types of
2058  *	attributes, there is no guarantee that the reported BSSs are
2059  *	fully complying with the match sets and userspace needs to be
2060  *	able to ignore them by itself.
2061  *	Thus, the implementation is somewhat hardware-dependent, but
2062  *	this is only an optimization and the userspace application
2063  *	needs to handle all the non-filtered results anyway.
2064  *	If the match attributes don't make sense when combined with
2065  *	the values passed in @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS (eg. if an SSID
2066  *	is included in the probe request, but the match attributes
2067  *	will never let it go through), -EINVAL may be returned.
2068  *	If omitted, no filtering is done.
2069  *
2070  * @NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS: Nested attribute listing the supported
2071  *	interface combinations. In each nested item, it contains attributes
2072  *	defined in &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
2073  *	If the wiphy uses multiple radios (@NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RADIOS is set),
2074  *	this attribute contains the interface combinations of the first radio.
2075  *	See @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS for the global wiphy
2076  *	combinations for the sum of all radios.
2077  * @NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES: Nested attribute (just like
2078  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES) containing the interface types that
2079  *	are managed in software: interfaces of these types aren't subject to
2080  *	any restrictions in their number or combinations.
2081  *
2082  * @NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA: nested attribute containing the information
2083  *	necessary for GTK rekeying in the device, see &enum nl80211_rekey_data.
2084  *
2085  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES: rates per to be advertised as supported in scan,
2086  *	nested array attribute containing an entry for each band, with the entry
2087  *	being a list of supported rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but
2088  *	without the length restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
2089  *
2090  * @NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID: indicates whether SSID is to be hidden from Beacon
2091  *	and Probe Response (when response to wildcard Probe Request); see
2092  *	&enum nl80211_hidden_ssid, represented as a u32
2093  *
2094  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP: Information element(s) for Probe Response frame.
2095  *	This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to
2096  *	provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into Probe Response frames when the
2097  *	driver (or firmware) replies to Probe Request frames.
2098  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP: Information element(s) for (Re)Association
2099  *	Response frames. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and
2100  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into
2101  *	(Re)Association Response frames when the driver (or firmware) replies to
2102  *	(Re)Association Request frames.
2103  *
2104  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME: Nested attribute containing the wme configuration
2105  *	of the station, see &enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr.
2106  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD: the device supports uapsd when working
2107  *	as AP.
2108  *
2109  * @NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT: Indicates whether the firmware is capable of
2110  *	roaming to another AP in the same ESS if the signal lever is low.
2111  *
2112  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: Nested attribute containing the PMKSA caching
2113  *	candidate information, see &enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr.
2114  *
2115  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE: Indicates whether to use CCK rate or not
2116  *	for management frames transmission. In order to avoid p2p probe/action
2117  *	frames are being transmitted at CCK rate in 2GHz band, the user space
2118  *	applications use this attribute.
2119  *	This attribute is used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and
2120  *	%NL80211_CMD_FRAME commands.
2121  *
2122  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION: Low level TDLS action code (e.g. link setup
2123  *	request, link setup confirm, link teardown, etc.). Values are
2124  *	described in the TDLS (802.11z) specification.
2125  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN: Non-zero token for uniquely identifying a
2126  *	TDLS conversation between two devices.
2127  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION: High level TDLS operation; see
2128  *	&enum nl80211_tdls_operation, represented as a u8.
2129  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT: A flag indicating the device can operate
2130  *	as a TDLS peer sta.
2131  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The TDLS discovery/setup and teardown
2132  *	procedures should be performed by sending TDLS packets via
2133  *	%NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT. Otherwise %NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
2134  *	used for asking the driver to perform a TDLS operation.
2135  *
2136  * @NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME: This u32 attribute may be listed for devices
2137  *	that have AP support to indicate that they have the AP SME integrated
2138  *	with support for the features listed in this attribute, see
2139  *	&enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
2140  *
2141  * @NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK: Used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME, this tells
2142  *	the driver to not wait for an acknowledgement. Note that due to this,
2143  *	it will also not give a status callback nor return a cookie. This is
2144  *	mostly useful for probe responses to save airtime.
2145  *
2146  * @NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS: This u32 attribute contains flags from
2147  *	&enum nl80211_feature_flags and is advertised in wiphy information.
2148  * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: Indicates that the HW responds to probe
2149  *	requests while operating in AP-mode.
2150  *	This attribute holds a bitmap of the supported protocols for
2151  *	offloading (see &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr).
2152  *
2153  * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response template data. Contains the entire
2154  *	probe-response frame. The DA field in the 802.11 header is zero-ed out,
2155  *	to be filled by the FW.
2156  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT: Force HT capable interfaces to disable
2157  *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
2158  *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
2159  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT: Force VHT capable interfaces to disable
2160  *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
2161  *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
2162  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HE: Force HE capable interfaces to disable
2163  *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
2164  *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
2165  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_EHT: Force EHT capable interfaces to disable
2166  *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
2167  *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
2168  * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK: Specify which bits of the
2169  *      ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY to which attention should be paid.
2170  *      Currently, only mac80211 NICs support this feature.
2171  *      The values that may be configured are:
2172  *       MCS rates, MAX-AMSDU, HT-20-40 and HT_CAP_SGI_40
2173  *       AMPDU density and AMPDU factor.
2174  *      All values are treated as suggestions and may be ignored
2175  *      by the driver as required.  The actual values may be seen in
2176  *      the station debugfs ht_caps file.
2177  * @NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY_MASK: Specify which bits of the
2178  *      ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY to which attention should be paid.
2179  *      Currently, only mac80211 NICs support this feature.
2180  *      All values are treated as suggestions and may be ignored
2181  *      by the driver as required.  The actual values may be seen in
2182  *      the station debugfs vht_caps file.
2183  *
2184  * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION: region for regulatory rules which this country
2185  *    abides to when initiating radiation on DFS channels. A country maps
2186  *    to one DFS region.
2187  *
2188  * @NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP: This u16 bitmap contains the No Ack Policy of
2189  *      up to 16 TIDs.
2190  *
2191  * @NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT: timeout value in seconds, this can be
2192  *	used by the drivers which has MLME in firmware and does not have support
2193  *	to report per station tx/rx activity to free up the station entry from
2194  *	the list. This needs to be used when the driver advertises the
2195  *	capability to timeout the stations.
2196  *
2197  * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM: signal strength in dBm (as a 32-bit int);
2198  *	this attribute is (depending on the driver capabilities) added to
2199  *	received frames indicated with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
2200  *
2201  * @NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD: Background scan period in seconds
2202  *      or 0 to disable background scan.
2203  *
2204  * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE: type of regulatory hint passed from
2205  *	userspace. If unset it is assumed the hint comes directly from
2206  *	a user. If set code could specify exactly what type of source
2207  *	was used to provide the hint. For the different types of
2208  *	allowed user regulatory hints see nl80211_user_reg_hint_type.
2209  *
2210  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON: The reason for which AP has rejected
2211  *	the connection request from a station. nl80211_connect_failed_reason
2212  *	enum has different reasons of connection failure.
2213  *
2214  * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA: Fields and elements in Authentication frames.
2215  *	This contains the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data),
2216  *	excluding the Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the
2217  *	Authentication transaction sequence number field. It is used with
2218  *	authentication algorithms that need special fields to be added into
2219  *	the frames (SAE and FILS). Currently, only the SAE cases use the
2220  *	initial two fields (Authentication transaction sequence number and
2221  *	Status code). However, those fields are included in the attribute data
2222  *	for all authentication algorithms to keep the attribute definition
2223  *	consistent.
2224  *
2225  * @NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY: VHT Capability information element (from
2226  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
2227  *
2228  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS: scan request control flags (u32)
2229  *
2230  * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW: P2P GO Client Traffic Window (u8), used with
2231  *	the START_AP and SET_BSS commands
2232  * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS: P2P GO opportunistic PS (u8), used with the
2233  *	START_AP and SET_BSS commands. This can have the values 0 or 1;
2234  *	if not given in START_AP 0 is assumed, if not given in SET_BSS
2235  *	no change is made.
2236  *
2237  * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE: local mesh STA link-specific power mode
2238  *	defined in &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode.
2239  *
2240  * @NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY: ACL policy, see &enum nl80211_acl_policy,
2241  *	carried in a u32 attribute
2242  *
2243  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS: Array of nested MAC addresses, used for
2244  *	MAC ACL.
2245  *
2246  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX: u32 attribute to advertise the maximum
2247  *	number of MAC addresses that a device can support for MAC
2248  *	ACL.
2249  *
2250  * @NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT: Type of radar event for notification to userspace,
2251  *	contains a value of enum nl80211_radar_event (u32).
2252  *
2253  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA: 802.11 extended capabilities that the kernel driver
2254  *	has and handles. The format is the same as the IE contents. See
2255  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for more information.
2256  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK: Extended capabilities that the kernel driver
2257  *	has set in the %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA value, for multibit fields.
2258  *
2259  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY: Station capabilities (u16) are advertised to
2260  *	the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS power save (PU-APSD).
2261  *
2262  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY: Station extended capabilities are
2263  *	advertised to the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS off channel operations
2264  *	and PU-APSD.
2265  *
2266  * @NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: global nl80211 feature flags, see
2267  *	&enum nl80211_protocol_features, the attribute is a u32.
2268  *
2269  * @NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: flag attribute, userspace supports
2270  *	receiving the data for a single wiphy split across multiple
2271  *	messages, given with wiphy dump message
2272  *
2273  * @NL80211_ATTR_MDID: Mobility Domain Identifier
2274  *
2275  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC: Resource Information Container Information
2276  *	Element
2277  *
2278  * @NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID: critical protocol identifier requiring increased
2279  *	reliability, see &enum nl80211_crit_proto_id (u16).
2280  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION: duration in milliseconds in which
2281  *      the connection should have increased reliability (u16).
2282  *
2283  * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID: Association ID for the peer TDLS station (u16).
2284  *	This is similar to @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID but with a difference of being
2285  *	allowed to be used with the first @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION command to
2286  *	update a TDLS peer STA entry.
2287  *
2288  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: Coalesce rule information.
2289  *
2290  * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT: u32 attribute specifying the number of TBTT's
2291  *	until the channel switch event.
2292  * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX: flag attribute specifying that transmission
2293  *	must be blocked on the current channel (before the channel switch
2294  *	operation). Also included in the channel switch started event if quiet
2295  *	was requested by the AP.
2296  * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES: Nested set of attributes containing the IE information
2297  *	for the time while performing a channel switch.
2298  * @NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel
2299  *	switch or color change counters in the beacons tail (%NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL).
2300  * @NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel
2301  *	switch or color change counters in the probe response (%NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP).
2302  *
2303  * @NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS: flags for nl80211_send_mgmt(), u32.
2304  *	As specified in the &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags.
2305  *
2306  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS: array of supported channels.
2307  *
2308  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES: array of supported
2309  *      operating classes.
2310  *
2311  * @NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS: A flag indicating whether user space
2312  *	controls DFS operation in IBSS mode. If the flag is included in
2313  *	%NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS request, the driver will allow use of DFS
2314  *	channels and reports radar events to userspace. Userspace is required
2315  *	to react to radar events, e.g. initiate a channel switch or leave the
2316  *	IBSS network.
2317  *
2318  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports
2319  *	5 MHz channel bandwidth.
2320  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports
2321  *	10 MHz channel bandwidth.
2322  *
2323  * @NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF: Operating mode field from Operating Mode
2324  *	Notification Element based on association request when used with
2325  *	%NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION or %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION (only when
2326  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE is supported, or with TDLS);
2327  *	u8 attribute.
2328  *
2329  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID: The vendor ID, either a 24-bit OUI or, if
2330  *	%NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX is set, a special Linux ID (not used yet)
2331  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD: vendor sub-command
2332  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA: data for the vendor command, if any; this
2333  *	attribute is also used for vendor command feature advertisement
2334  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS: used for event list advertising in the wiphy
2335  *	info, containing a nested array of possible events
2336  *
2337  * @NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP: IP DSCP mapping for Interworking QoS mapping. This
2338  *	data is in the format defined for the payload of the QoS Map Set element
2339  *	in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97.
2340  *
2341  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT: MAC address recommendation as initial BSS
2342  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT: frequency of the recommended initial BSS
2343  *
2344  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA: Device attribute that indicates how many
2345  *	associated stations are supported in AP mode (including P2P GO); u32.
2346  *	Since drivers may not have a fixed limit on the maximum number (e.g.,
2347  *	other concurrent operations may affect this), drivers are allowed to
2348  *	advertise values that cannot always be met. In such cases, an attempt
2349  *	to add a new station entry with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION may fail.
2350  *
2351  * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX: An array of csa counter offsets (u16) which
2352  *	should be updated when the frame is transmitted.
2353  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS: U8 attribute used to advertise the maximum
2354  *	supported number of csa counters.
2355  *
2356  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY: flags for TDLS peer capabilities, u32.
2357  *	As specified in the &enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability.
2358  *
2359  * @NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER: Flag attribute, if set during interface
2360  *	creation then the new interface will be owned by the netlink socket
2361  *	that created it and will be destroyed when the socket is closed.
2362  *	If set during scheduled scan start then the new scan req will be
2363  *	owned by the netlink socket that created it and the scheduled scan will
2364  *	be stopped when the socket is closed.
2365  *	If set during configuration of regulatory indoor operation then the
2366  *	regulatory indoor configuration would be owned by the netlink socket
2367  *	that configured the indoor setting, and the indoor operation would be
2368  *	cleared when the socket is closed.
2369  *	If set during NAN interface creation, the interface will be destroyed
2370  *	if the socket is closed just like any other interface. Moreover, NAN
2371  *	notifications will be sent in unicast to that socket. Without this
2372  *	attribute, the notifications will be sent to the %NL80211_MCGRP_NAN
2373  *	multicast group.
2374  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT the
2375  *	station will deauthenticate when the socket is closed.
2376  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS the IBSS will be automatically
2377  *	torn down when the socket is closed.
2378  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH the mesh setup will be
2379  *	automatically torn down when the socket is closed.
2380  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_START_AP the AP will be automatically
2381  *	disabled when the socket is closed.
2382  *
2383  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR: flag attribute indicating the current end is
2384  *	the TDLS link initiator.
2385  *
2386  * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM: flag for indicating whether the current connection
2387  *	shall support Radio Resource Measurements (11k). This attribute can be
2388  *	used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests.
2389  *	User space applications are expected to use this flag only if the
2390  *	underlying device supports these minimal RRM features:
2391  *		%NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES,
2392  *		%NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET,
2393  *	Or, if global RRM is supported, see:
2394  *		%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM
2395  *	If this flag is used, driver must add the Power Capabilities IE to the
2396  *	association request. In addition, it must also set the RRM capability
2397  *	flag in the association request's Capability Info field.
2398  *
2399  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK: flag attribute used to enable ACK timeout
2400  *	estimation algorithm (dynack). In order to activate dynack
2401  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION feature flag must be set by lower
2402  *	drivers to indicate dynack capability. Dynack is automatically disabled
2403  *	setting valid value for coverage class.
2404  *
2405  * @NL80211_ATTR_TSID: a TSID value (u8 attribute)
2406  * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO: user priority value (u8 attribute)
2407  * @NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME: admitted time in units of 32 microseconds
2408  *	(per second) (u16 attribute)
2409  *
2410  * @NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE: SMPS mode to use (ap mode). see
2411  *	&enum nl80211_smps_mode.
2412  *
2413  * @NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS: operating class
2414  *
2415  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK: MAC address mask
2416  *
2417  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG: flag attribute indicating this device
2418  *	is self-managing its regulatory information and any regulatory domain
2419  *	obtained from it is coming from the device's wiphy and not the global
2420  *	cfg80211 regdomain.
2421  *
2422  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES: extended feature flags contained in a byte
2423  *	array. The feature flags are identified by their bit index (see &enum
2424  *	nl80211_ext_feature_index). The bit index is ordered starting at the
2425  *	least-significant bit of the first byte in the array, ie. bit index 0
2426  *	is located at bit 0 of byte 0. bit index 25 would be located at bit 1
2427  *	of byte 3 (u8 array).
2428  *
2429  * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS: Request overall radio statistics to be
2430  *	returned along with other survey data. If set, @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY
2431  *	may return a survey entry without a channel indicating global radio
2432  *	statistics (only some values are valid and make sense.)
2433  *	For devices that don't return such an entry even then, the information
2434  *	should be contained in the result as the sum of the respective counters
2435  *	over all channels.
2436  *
2437  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY: delay before the first cycle of a
2438  *	scheduled scan is started.  Or the delay before a WoWLAN
2439  *	net-detect scan is started, counting from the moment the
2440  *	system is suspended.  This value is a u32, in seconds.
2441  *
2442  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR: flag attribute, if set indicates that the device
2443  *      is operating in an indoor environment.
2444  *
2445  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: maximum number of scan plans for
2446  *	scheduled scan supported by the device (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2447  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: maximum interval (in seconds) for
2448  *	a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2449  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: maximum number of iterations in
2450  *	a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2451  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: a list of scan plans for scheduled scan.
2452  *	Each scan plan defines the number of scan iterations and the interval
2453  *	between scans. The last scan plan will always run infinitely,
2454  *	thus it must not specify the number of iterations, only the interval
2455  *	between scans. The scan plans are executed sequentially.
2456  *	Each scan plan is a nested attribute of &enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan.
2457  * @NL80211_ATTR_PBSS: flag attribute. If set it means operate
2458  *	in a PBSS. Specified in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to request
2459  *	connecting to a PCP, and in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP to start
2460  *	a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG networks only.
2461  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT: nested attribute for driver supporting the
2462  *	BSS selection feature. When used with %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY it contains
2463  *	attributes according &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr to indicate what
2464  *	BSS selection behaviours are supported. When used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
2465  *	it contains the behaviour-specific attribute containing the parameters for
2466  *	BSS selection to be done by driver and/or firmware.
2467  *
2468  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS: whether P2P PS mechanism supported
2469  *	or not. u8, one of the values of &enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status
2470  *
2471  * @NL80211_ATTR_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
2472  *
2473  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA: Nested attribute of the following attributes:
2474  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA,
2475  *	%NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK, to specify the extended capabilities and
2476  *	other interface-type specific capabilities per interface type. For MLO,
2477  *	%NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY and %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS are
2478  *	present.
2479  *
2480  * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA: array of 24 bytes that defines a MU-MIMO
2481  *	groupID for monitor mode.
2482  *	The first 8 bytes are a mask that defines the membership in each
2483  *	group (there are 64 groups, group 0 and 63 are reserved),
2484  *	each bit represents a group and set to 1 for being a member in
2485  *	that group and 0 for not being a member.
2486  *	The remaining 16 bytes define the position in each group: 2 bits for
2487  *	each group.
2488  *	(smaller group numbers represented on most significant bits and bigger
2489  *	group numbers on least significant bits.)
2490  *	This attribute is used only if all interfaces are in monitor mode.
2491  *	Set this attribute in order to monitor packets using the given MU-MIMO
2492  *	groupID data.
2493  *	to turn off that feature set all the bits of the groupID to zero.
2494  * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR: mac address for the sniffer to follow
2495  *	when using MU-MIMO air sniffer.
2496  *	to turn that feature off set an invalid mac address
2497  *	(e.g. FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF)
2498  *
2499  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF: The time at which the scan was actually
2500  *	started (u64). The time is the TSF of the BSS the interface that
2501  *	requested the scan is connected to (if available, otherwise this
2502  *	attribute must not be included).
2503  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID: The BSS according to which
2504  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF is set.
2505  * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION: measurement duration in TUs (u16). If
2506  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY is not set, this is the
2507  *	maximum measurement duration allowed. This attribute is used with
2508  *	measurement requests. It can also be used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN
2509  *	if the scan is used for beacon report radio measurement.
2510  * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY: flag attribute that indicates
2511  *	that the duration specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION is
2512  *	mandatory. If this flag is not set, the duration is the maximum duration
2513  *	and the actual measurement duration may be shorter.
2514  *
2515  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID: Association ID for the mesh peer (u16). This is
2516  *	used to pull the stored data for mesh peer in power save state.
2517  *
2518  * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF: the master preference to be used by
2519  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and optionally with
2520  *	%NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG. Its type is u8 and it can't be 0.
2521  *	Also, values 1 and 255 are reserved for certification purposes and
2522  *	should not be used during a normal device operation.
2523  * @NL80211_ATTR_BANDS: operating bands configuration.  This is a u32
2524  *	bitmask of BIT(NL80211_BAND_*) as described in %enum
2525  *	nl80211_band.  For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0
2526  *	would be set.  This attribute is used with
2527  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and %NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG, and
2528  *	it is optional.  If no bands are set, it means don't-care and
2529  *	the device will decide what to use.
2530  * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC: a function that can be added to NAN. See
2531  *	&enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes for description of this nested
2532  *	attribute.
2533  * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH: used to report a match. This is a nested attribute.
2534  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes.
2535  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK: KEK for FILS (Re)Association Request/Response frame
2536  *	protection.
2537  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES: Nonces (part of AAD) for FILS (Re)Association
2538  *	Request/Response frame protection. This attribute contains the 16 octet
2539  *	STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
2540  *
2541  * @NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED: Indicates whether or not multicast
2542  *	packets should be send out as unicast to all stations (flag attribute).
2543  *
2544  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSSID: The BSSID of the AP. Note that %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is also
2545  *	used in various commands/events for specifying the BSSID.
2546  *
2547  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: Relative RSSI threshold by which
2548  *	other BSSs has to be better or slightly worse than the current
2549  *	connected BSS so that they get reported to user space.
2550  *	This will give an opportunity to userspace to consider connecting to
2551  *	other matching BSSs which have better or slightly worse RSSI than
2552  *	the current connected BSS by using an offloaded operation to avoid
2553  *	unnecessary wakeups.
2554  *
2555  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for BSSs in
2556  *	the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
2557  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI based comparison to figure out
2558  *	better BSSs. The attribute value is a packed structure
2559  *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
2560  *
2561  * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON: The reason for which an operation timed out.
2562  *	u32 attribute with an &enum nl80211_timeout_reason value. This is used,
2563  *	e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT event.
2564  *
2565  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP)
2566  *	username part of NAI used to refer keys rRK and rIK. This is used with
2567  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2568  *
2569  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP) realm part
2570  *	of NAI specifying the domain name of the ER server. This is used with
2571  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2572  *
2573  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM: Unsigned 16-bit ERP next sequence number
2574  *	to use in ERP messages. This is used in generating the FILS wrapped data
2575  *	for FILS authentication and is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2576  *
2577  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) for the
2578  *	NAI specified by %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME and
2579  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM. This is used for generating rIK and rMSK
2580  *	from successful FILS authentication and is used with
2581  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2582  *
2583  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID: A 2-octet identifier advertised by a FILS AP
2584  *	identifying the scope of PMKSAs. This is used with
2585  *	@NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA.
2586  *
2587  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK: attribute for passing PMK key material. Used with
2588  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA for the PMKSA identified by %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID.
2589  *	For %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP it is used to provide
2590  *	PSK for offloading 4-way handshake for WPA/WPA2-PSK networks. For 802.1X
2591  *	authentication it is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT
2592  *	support this attribute specifies the PMK-R0 if NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME
2593  *	is included as well.
2594  *
2595  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI: flag attribute which user-space shall use to
2596  *	indicate that it supports multiple active scheduled scan requests.
2597  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS: indicates maximum number of scheduled
2598  *	scan request that may be active for the device (u32).
2599  *
2600  * @NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS: flag attribute which user-space can include
2601  *	in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to indicate that for 802.1X authentication it
2602  *	wants to use the supported offload of the 4-way handshake.
2603  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME: PMK-R0 Name for offloaded FT.
2604  * @NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED: (reserved)
2605  *
2606  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION: Identify the requested external
2607  *     authentication operation (u32 attribute with an
2608  *     &enum nl80211_external_auth_action value). This is used with the
2609  *     %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH request event.
2610  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: Flag attribute indicating that the user
2611  *	space supports external authentication. This attribute shall be used
2612  *	with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP request. The driver
2613  *	may offload authentication processing to user space if this capability
2614  *	is indicated in the respective requests from the user space. (This flag
2615  *	attribute deprecated for %NL80211_CMD_START_AP, use
2616  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS)
2617  *
2618  * @NL80211_ATTR_NSS: Station's New/updated  RX_NSS value notified using this
2619  *	u8 attribute. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED.
2620  *
2621  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS: TXQ statistics (nested attribute, see &enum
2622  *      nl80211_txq_stats)
2623  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT: Total packet limit for the TXQ queues for this phy.
2624  *      The smaller of this and the memory limit is enforced.
2625  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: Total memory limit (in bytes) for the
2626  *      TXQ queues for this phy. The smaller of this and the packet limit is
2627  *      enforced.
2628  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum (bytes). Number of bytes
2629  *      a flow is assigned on each round of the DRR scheduler.
2630  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY: HE Capability information element (from
2631  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). Can be set
2632  *	only if %NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME is set.
2633  *
2634  * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER: nested attribute which user-space can include
2635  *	in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP or %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON for fine timing
2636  *	measurement (FTM) responder functionality and containing parameters as
2637  *	possible, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attr
2638  *
2639  * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Nested attribute with FTM responder
2640  *	statistics, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats.
2641  *
2642  * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT: Timeout for the given operation in milliseconds (u32),
2643  *	if the attribute is not given no timeout is requested. Note that 0 is an
2644  *	invalid value.
2645  *
2646  * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS: peer measurements request (and result)
2647  *	data, uses nested attributes specified in
2648  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs.
2649  *	This is also used for capability advertisement in the wiphy information,
2650  *	with the appropriate sub-attributes.
2651  *
2652  * @NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: Station's weight when scheduled by the airtime
2653  *	scheduler.
2654  *
2655  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type (u8) for
2656  *	station associated with the AP. See &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for
2657  *	possible values.
2658  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER: Transmit power level (s16) in dBm units. This
2659  *	allows to set Tx power for a station. If this attribute is not included,
2660  *	the default per-interface tx power setting will be overriding. Driver
2661  *	should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx power per-interface
2662  *	or per-station.
2663  *
2664  * @NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD: attribute for passing SAE password material. It
2665  *	is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to provide password for offloading
2666  *	SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks.
2667  *
2668  * @NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER: Enable target wait time responder support.
2669  *
2670  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD: nested attribute for OBSS Packet Detection
2671  *	functionality.
2672  *
2673  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz
2674  *	channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions.
2675  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251. (u8 attribute)
2676  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
2677  *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations. (u8 attribute)
2678  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13.
2679  *
2680  * @NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID: VLAN ID (1..4094) for the station and VLAN group key
2681  *	(u16).
2682  *
2683  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR: nested attribute for BSS Color Settings.
2684  *
2685  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES: nested array attribute, with each entry
2686  *	using attributes from &enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes. This
2687  *	attribute is sent in a response to %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY indicating
2688  *	supported AKM suites capability per interface. AKMs advertised in
2689  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES are default capabilities if AKM suites not
2690  *	advertised for a specific interface type.
2691  *
2692  * @NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG: TID specific configuration in a
2693  *	nested attribute with &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr sub-attributes;
2694  *	on output (in wiphy attributes) it contains only the feature sub-
2695  *	attributes.
2696  *
2697  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH: disable preauth frame rx on control
2698  *	port in order to forward/receive them as ordinary data frames.
2699  *
2700  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds (u32,
2701  *	dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold; 0 is not a valid value).
2702  *	An optional parameter configured through %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA.
2703  *	Drivers that trigger roaming need to know the lifetime of the
2704  *	configured PMKSA for triggering the full vs. PMKSA caching based
2705  *	authentication. This timeout helps authentication methods like SAE,
2706  *	where PMK gets updated only by going through a full (new SAE)
2707  *	authentication instead of getting updated during an association for EAP
2708  *	authentication. No new full authentication within the PMK expiry shall
2709  *	result in a disassociation at the end of the lifetime.
2710  *
2711  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK_REAUTH_THRESHOLD: Reauthentication threshold time, in
2712  *	terms of percentage of %NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME
2713  *	(u8, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold, 1..100). This is an optional
2714  *	parameter configured through %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA. Requests the
2715  *	driver to trigger a full authentication roam (without PMKSA caching)
2716  *	after the reauthentication threshold time, but before the PMK lifetime
2717  *	has expired.
2718  *
2719  *	Authentication methods like SAE need to be able to generate a new PMKSA
2720  *	entry without having to force a disconnection after the PMK timeout. If
2721  *	no roaming occurs between the reauth threshold and PMK expiration,
2722  *	disassociation is still forced.
2723  * @NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST: multicast flag for the
2724  *	%NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command, see the description there.
2725  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET: offset of the associated
2726  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ in positive KHz. Only valid when supplied with
2727  *	an %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET.
2728  * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1_OFFSET: Center frequency offset in KHz for the
2729  *	first channel segment specified in %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1.
2730  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ: nested attribute with KHz frequencies
2731  *
2732  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPABILITY: HE 6 GHz Band Capability element (from
2733  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION).
2734  *
2735  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_DISCOVERY: Optional parameter to configure FILS
2736  *	discovery. It is a nested attribute, see
2737  *	&enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes. Userspace should pass an empty
2738  *	nested attribute to disable this feature and delete the templates.
2739  *
2740  * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Optional parameter to configure
2741  *	unsolicited broadcast probe response. It is a nested attribute, see
2742  *	&enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes. Userspace should pass an empty
2743  *	nested attribute to disable this feature and delete the templates.
2744  *
2745  * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY: S1G Capability information element (from
2746  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
2747  * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY_MASK: S1G Capability Information element
2748  *	override mask. Used with NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY in
2749  *	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2750  *
2751  * @NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PWE: Indicates the mechanism(s) allowed for SAE PWE
2752  *	derivation in WPA3-Personal networks which are using SAE authentication.
2753  *	This is a u8 attribute that encapsulates one of the values from
2754  *	&enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism.
2755  *
2756  * @NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC: SAR power limitation specification when
2757  *	used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS. The message contains fields
2758  *	of %nl80211_sar_attrs which specifies the sar type and related
2759  *	sar specs. Sar specs contains array of %nl80211_sar_specs_attrs.
2760  *
2761  * @NL80211_ATTR_RECONNECT_REQUESTED: flag attribute, used with deauth and
2762  *	disassoc events to indicate that an immediate reconnect to the AP
2763  *	is desired.
2764  *
2765  * @NL80211_ATTR_OBSS_COLOR_BITMAP: bitmap of the u64 BSS colors for the
2766  *	%NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION event.
2767  *
2768  * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COUNT: u8 attribute specifying the number of TBTT's
2769  *	until the color switch event.
2770  * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COLOR: u8 attribute specifying the color that we are
2771  *	switching to
2772  * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_ELEMS: Nested set of attributes containing the IE
2773  *	information for the time while performing a color switch.
2774  *
2775  * @NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG: Nested attribute for multiple BSSID
2776  *	advertisements (MBSSID) parameters in AP mode.
2777  *	Kernel uses this attribute to indicate the driver's support for MBSSID
2778  *	and enhanced multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA AP) to the userspace.
2779  *	Userspace should use this attribute to configure per interface MBSSID
2780  *	parameters.
2781  *	See &enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes for details.
2782  *
2783  * @NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS: Nested parameter to pass multiple BSSID elements.
2784  *	Mandatory parameter for the transmitting interface to enable MBSSID.
2785  *	Optional for the non-transmitting interfaces.
2786  *
2787  * @NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_BACKGROUND: Configure dedicated offchannel chain
2788  *	available for radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used
2789  *	to transmit or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
2790  *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
2791  *	switching on a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
2792  *	radar channel.
2793  *
2794  * @NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS: u32 attribute contains ap settings flags,
2795  *	enumerated in &enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags. This attribute shall be
2796  *	used with %NL80211_CMD_START_AP request.
2797  *
2798  * @NL80211_ATTR_EHT_CAPABILITY: EHT Capability information element (from
2799  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). Can be set
2800  *	only if %NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME is set.
2801  *
2802  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID: A (u8) link ID for use with MLO, to be used with
2803  *	various commands that need a link ID to operate.
2804  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS: A nested array of links, each containing some
2805  *	per-link information and a link ID.
2806  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR: An MLD address, used with various commands such as
2807  *	authenticate/associate.
2808  *
2809  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT: Flag attribute to indicate user space supports MLO
2810  *	connection. Used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. If this attribute is not
2811  *	included in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT drivers must not perform MLO connection.
2812  *
2813  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES: U16 attribute. Indicates maximum number of
2814  *	AKM suites allowed for %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
2815  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_AP in %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY response. If this
2816  *	attribute is not present userspace shall consider maximum number of AKM
2817  *	suites allowed as %NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES which is the legacy maximum
2818  *	number prior to the introduction of this attribute.
2819  *
2820  * @NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY: EML Capability information (u16)
2821  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS: MLD Capabilities and Operations (u16)
2822  *
2823  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP: Hardware timestamp for TX operation in
2824  *	nanoseconds (u64). This is the device clock timestamp so it will
2825  *	probably reset when the device is stopped or the firmware is reset.
2826  *	When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, indicates the frame TX
2827  *	timestamp. When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME RX notification, indicates
2828  *	the ack TX timestamp.
2829  * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP: Hardware timestamp for RX operation in
2830  *	nanoseconds (u64). This is the device clock timestamp so it will
2831  *	probably reset when the device is stopped or the firmware is reset.
2832  *	When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, indicates the ack RX
2833  *	timestamp. When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME RX notification, indicates
2834  *	the incoming frame RX timestamp.
2835  * @NL80211_ATTR_TD_BITMAP: Transition Disable bitmap, for subsequent
2836  *	(re)associations.
2837  *
2838  * @NL80211_ATTR_PUNCT_BITMAP: (u32) Preamble puncturing bitmap, lowest
2839  *	bit corresponds to the lowest 20 MHz channel. Each bit set to 1
2840  *	indicates that the sub-channel is punctured. Higher 16 bits are
2841  *	reserved.
2842  *
2843  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS: Maximum number of peers that HW
2844  *	timestamping can be enabled for concurrently (u16), a wiphy attribute.
2845  *	A value of 0xffff indicates setting for all peers (i.e. not specifying
2846  *	an address with %NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP) is supported.
2847  * @NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED: Indicates whether HW timestamping should
2848  *	be enabled or not (flag attribute).
2849  *
2850  * @NL80211_ATTR_EMA_RNR_ELEMS: Optional nested attribute for
2851  *	reduced neighbor report (RNR) elements. This attribute can be used
2852  *	only when NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA is enabled.
2853  *	Userspace is responsible for splitting the RNR into multiple
2854  *	elements such that each element excludes the non-transmitting
2855  *	profiles already included in the MBSSID element
2856  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS) at the same index. Each EMA beacon
2857  *	will be generated by adding MBSSID and RNR elements at the same
2858  *	index. If the userspace includes more RNR elements than number of
2859  *	MBSSID elements then these will be added in every EMA beacon.
2860  *
2861  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_DISABLED: Flag attribute indicating that the link is
2862  *	disabled.
2863  *
2864  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_DUMP_INCLUDE_USE_DATA: Include BSS usage data, i.e.
2865  *	include BSSes that can only be used in restricted scenarios and/or
2866  *	cannot be used at all.
2867  *
2868  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_DLINK: Binary attribute specifying the downlink TID to
2869  *      link mapping. The length is 8 * sizeof(u16). For each TID the link
2870  *      mapping is as defined in section 9.4.2.314 (TID-To-Link Mapping element)
2871  *      in Draft P802.11be_D4.0.
2872  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_ULINK: Binary attribute specifying the uplink TID to
2873  *      link mapping. The length is 8 * sizeof(u16). For each TID the link
2874  *      mapping is as defined in section 9.4.2.314 (TID-To-Link Mapping element)
2875  *      in Draft P802.11be_D4.0.
2876  *
2877  * @NL80211_ATTR_ASSOC_SPP_AMSDU: flag attribute used with
2878  *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE indicating the SPP A-MSDUs
2879  *	are used on this connection
2880  *
2881  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RADIOS: Nested attribute describing physical radios
2882  *	belonging to this wiphy. See &enum nl80211_wiphy_radio_attrs.
2883  *
2884  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS: Nested attribute listing the
2885  *	supported interface combinations for all radios combined. In each
2886  *	nested item, it contains attributes defined in
2887  *	&enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
2888  *
2889  * @NL80211_ATTR_VIF_RADIO_MASK: Bitmask of allowed radios (u32).
2890  *	A value of 0 means all radios.
2891  *
2892  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_SELECTORS: supported BSS Membership Selectors, array
2893  *	of supported selectors as defined by IEEE Std 802.11-2020 9.4.2.3 but
2894  *	without the length restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_SELECTORS).
2895  *	This can be used to provide a list of selectors that are implemented
2896  *	by the supplicant. If not given, support for SAE_H2E is assumed.
2897  *
2898  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_RECONF_REM_LINKS: (u16) A bitmask of the links requested
2899  *      to be removed from the MLO association.
2900  *
2901  * @NL80211_ATTR_EPCS: Flag attribute indicating that EPCS is enabled for a
2902  *	station interface.
2903  *
2904  * @NL80211_ATTR_ASSOC_MLD_EXT_CAPA_OPS: Extended MLD capabilities and
2905  *	operations that userspace implements to use during association/ML
2906  *	link reconfig, currently only "BTM MLD Recommendation For Multiple
2907  *	APs Support". Drivers may set additional flags that they support
2908  *	in the kernel or device.
2909  *
2910  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RADIO_INDEX: (int) Integer attribute denoting the index
2911  *	of the radio in interest. Internally a value of -1 is used to
2912  *	indicate that the radio id is not given in user-space. This means
2913  *	that all the attributes are applicable to all the radios. If there is
2914  *	a radio index provided in user-space, the attributes will be
2915  *	applicable to that specific radio only. If the radio id is greater
2916  *	thank the number of radios, error denoting invalid value is returned.
2917  *
2918  * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_LONG_BEACON_PERIOD: (u8) Integer attribute that represents
2919  *	the number of beacon intervals between each long beacon transmission
2920  *	for an S1G BSS with short beaconing enabled. This is a required
2921  *	attribute for initialising an S1G short beaconing BSS. When updating
2922  *	the short beacon data, this is not required. It has a minimum value of
2923  *	2 (i.e 2 beacon intervals).
2924  *
2925  * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_SHORT_BEACON: Nested attribute containing the short beacon
2926  *	head and tail used to set or update the short beacon templates. When
2927  *	bringing up a new interface, %NL80211_ATTR_S1G_LONG_BEACON_PERIOD is
2928  *	required alongside this attribute. Refer to
2929  *	@enum nl80211_s1g_short_beacon_attrs for the attribute definitions.
2930  *
2931  * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR: total number of nl80211_attrs available
2932  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number currently defined
2933  * @__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
2934  */
2935 enum nl80211_attrs {
2936 /* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */
2937 	NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC,
2938 
2939 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY,
2940 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME,
2941 
2942 	NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX,
2943 	NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME,
2944 	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE,
2945 
2946 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC,
2947 
2948 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA,
2949 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX,
2950 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER,
2951 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ,
2952 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT,
2953 
2954 	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL,
2955 	NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD,
2956 	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD,
2957 	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL,
2958 
2959 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID,
2960 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS,
2961 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL,
2962 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES,
2963 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN,
2964 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO,
2965 
2966 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS,
2967 
2968 	NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS,
2969 
2970 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID,
2971 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION,
2972 	NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP,
2973 	NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO,
2974 
2975 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT,
2976 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
2977 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME,
2978 
2979 	NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY,
2980 
2981 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES,
2982 
2983 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2,
2984 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES,
2985 
2986 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG,
2987 
2988 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES,
2989 
2990 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS,
2991 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
2992 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE,
2993 
2994 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT,
2995 
2996 	NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE,
2997 	NL80211_ATTR_IE,
2998 
2999 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS,
3000 
3001 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES,
3002 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS,
3003 	NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION, /* replaces old SCAN_GENERATION */
3004 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS,
3005 
3006 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR,
3007 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE,
3008 
3009 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS,
3010 
3011 	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME,
3012 	NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
3013 	NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE,
3014 	NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE,
3015 
3016 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE,
3017 
3018 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN,
3019 	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES,
3020 
3021 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE,
3022 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER,
3023 
3024 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED,
3025 
3026 
3027 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT,
3028 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG,
3029 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD,
3030 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD,
3031 
3032 	NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT,
3033 
3034 	NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP,
3035 
3036 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2,
3037 
3038 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT,
3039 
3040 	NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA,
3041 
3042 	NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY,
3043 
3044 	NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP,
3045 	NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE,
3046 
3047 	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE,
3048 	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP,
3049 	NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS,
3050 	NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES,
3051 
3052 	NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE,
3053 	NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE,
3054 
3055 	NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID,
3056 
3057 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY,
3058 	NL80211_ATTR_KEYS,
3059 
3060 	NL80211_ATTR_PID,
3061 
3062 	NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR,
3063 
3064 	NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO,
3065 
3066 	NL80211_ATTR_PMKID,
3067 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS,
3068 
3069 	NL80211_ATTR_DURATION,
3070 
3071 	NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE,
3072 
3073 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS,
3074 
3075 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES,
3076 
3077 	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH,
3078 
3079 	NL80211_ATTR_ACK,
3080 
3081 	NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE,
3082 
3083 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM,
3084 
3085 	NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE,
3086 
3087 	NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE,
3088 
3089 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING,
3090 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL,
3091 
3092 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES,
3093 	NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES,
3094 	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE,
3095 
3096 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
3097 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT,
3098 
3099 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN,
3100 
3101 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX,
3102 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX,
3103 
3104 	NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE,
3105 
3106 	NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK,
3107 
3108 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE,
3109 
3110 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES,
3111 
3112 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION,
3113 
3114 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP,
3115 
3116 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX,
3117 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX,
3118 
3119 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH,
3120 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE,
3121 
3122 	NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS,
3123 	NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED,
3124 
3125 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL,
3126 
3127 	NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS,
3128 	NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES,
3129 
3130 	NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA,
3131 
3132 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS,
3133 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN,
3134 
3135 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES,
3136 
3137 	NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID,
3138 
3139 	NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP,
3140 	NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP,
3141 
3142 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME,
3143 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD,
3144 
3145 	NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT,
3146 
3147 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH,
3148 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS,
3149 
3150 	NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
3151 
3152 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE,
3153 
3154 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION,
3155 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN,
3156 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION,
3157 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT,
3158 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP,
3159 
3160 	NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME,
3161 
3162 	NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK,
3163 
3164 	NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS,
3165 
3166 	NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD,
3167 
3168 	NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP,
3169 
3170 	NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION,
3171 
3172 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT,
3173 	NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK,
3174 
3175 	NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP,
3176 
3177 	NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT,
3178 
3179 	NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM,
3180 
3181 	NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD,
3182 
3183 	NL80211_ATTR_WDEV,
3184 
3185 	NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE,
3186 
3187 	NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON,
3188 
3189 	NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA,
3190 
3191 	NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY,
3192 
3193 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS,
3194 
3195 	NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,
3196 	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1,
3197 	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2,
3198 
3199 	NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW,
3200 	NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS,
3201 
3202 	NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE,
3203 
3204 	NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY,
3205 
3206 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS,
3207 
3208 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX,
3209 
3210 	NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT,
3211 
3212 	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA,
3213 	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK,
3214 
3215 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY,
3216 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY,
3217 
3218 	NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES,
3219 	NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP,
3220 
3221 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT,
3222 	NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY_MASK,
3223 
3224 	NL80211_ATTR_MDID,
3225 	NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC,
3226 
3227 	NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID,
3228 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION,
3229 
3230 	NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID,
3231 
3232 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE,
3233 
3234 	NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT,
3235 	NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX,
3236 	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES,
3237 	NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON,
3238 	NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP,
3239 
3240 	NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS,
3241 
3242 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS,
3243 
3244 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES,
3245 
3246 	NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS,
3247 
3248 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ,
3249 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ,
3250 
3251 	NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF,
3252 
3253 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID,
3254 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD,
3255 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
3256 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS,
3257 
3258 	NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP,
3259 
3260 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT,
3261 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT,
3262 
3263 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA,
3264 
3265 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY,
3266 
3267 	NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER,
3268 
3269 	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX,
3270 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS,
3271 
3272 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR,
3273 
3274 	NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM,
3275 
3276 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK,
3277 
3278 	NL80211_ATTR_TSID,
3279 	NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO,
3280 	NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME,
3281 
3282 	NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE,
3283 
3284 	NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS,
3285 
3286 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK,
3287 
3288 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG,
3289 
3290 	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES,
3291 
3292 	NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS,
3293 
3294 	NL80211_ATTR_NETNS_FD,
3295 
3296 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY,
3297 
3298 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR,
3299 
3300 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS,
3301 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL,
3302 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS,
3303 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS,
3304 
3305 	NL80211_ATTR_PBSS,
3306 
3307 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT,
3308 
3309 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS,
3310 
3311 	NL80211_ATTR_PAD,
3312 
3313 	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA,
3314 
3315 	NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA,
3316 	NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR,
3317 
3318 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF,
3319 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID,
3320 	NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION,
3321 	NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY,
3322 
3323 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID,
3324 
3325 	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF,
3326 	NL80211_ATTR_BANDS,
3327 	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC,
3328 	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH,
3329 
3330 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK,
3331 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES,
3332 
3333 	NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED,
3334 
3335 	NL80211_ATTR_BSSID,
3336 
3337 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI,
3338 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST,
3339 
3340 	NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON,
3341 
3342 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME,
3343 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM,
3344 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM,
3345 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK,
3346 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID,
3347 
3348 	NL80211_ATTR_PMK,
3349 
3350 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI,
3351 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS,
3352 
3353 	NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS,
3354 	NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME,
3355 	NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED,
3356 
3357 	NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION,
3358 	NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT,
3359 
3360 	NL80211_ATTR_NSS,
3361 	NL80211_ATTR_ACK_SIGNAL,
3362 
3363 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211,
3364 
3365 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS,
3366 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT,
3367 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT,
3368 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM,
3369 
3370 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY,
3371 
3372 	NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER,
3373 
3374 	NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS,
3375 
3376 	NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT,
3377 
3378 	NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS,
3379 
3380 	NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT,
3381 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING,
3382 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER,
3383 
3384 	NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD,
3385 
3386 	NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER,
3387 
3388 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD,
3389 
3390 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS,
3391 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG,
3392 
3393 	NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID,
3394 
3395 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR,
3396 
3397 	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES,
3398 
3399 	NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG,
3400 
3401 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH,
3402 
3403 	NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME,
3404 	NL80211_ATTR_PMK_REAUTH_THRESHOLD,
3405 
3406 	NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST,
3407 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET,
3408 	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1_OFFSET,
3409 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ,
3410 
3411 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPABILITY,
3412 
3413 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_DISCOVERY,
3414 
3415 	NL80211_ATTR_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
3416 
3417 	NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY,
3418 	NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY_MASK,
3419 
3420 	NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PWE,
3421 
3422 	NL80211_ATTR_RECONNECT_REQUESTED,
3423 
3424 	NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC,
3425 
3426 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HE,
3427 
3428 	NL80211_ATTR_OBSS_COLOR_BITMAP,
3429 
3430 	NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COUNT,
3431 	NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COLOR,
3432 	NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_ELEMS,
3433 
3434 	NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG,
3435 	NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS,
3436 
3437 	NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_BACKGROUND,
3438 
3439 	NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS,
3440 
3441 	NL80211_ATTR_EHT_CAPABILITY,
3442 
3443 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_EHT,
3444 
3445 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS,
3446 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID,
3447 	NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR,
3448 
3449 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT,
3450 
3451 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES,
3452 
3453 	NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY,
3454 	NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS,
3455 
3456 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP,
3457 	NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP,
3458 	NL80211_ATTR_TD_BITMAP,
3459 
3460 	NL80211_ATTR_PUNCT_BITMAP,
3461 
3462 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS,
3463 	NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED,
3464 
3465 	NL80211_ATTR_EMA_RNR_ELEMS,
3466 
3467 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_DISABLED,
3468 
3469 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_DUMP_INCLUDE_USE_DATA,
3470 
3471 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_DLINK,
3472 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_ULINK,
3473 
3474 	NL80211_ATTR_ASSOC_SPP_AMSDU,
3475 
3476 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RADIOS,
3477 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS,
3478 
3479 	NL80211_ATTR_VIF_RADIO_MASK,
3480 
3481 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_SELECTORS,
3482 
3483 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_RECONF_REM_LINKS,
3484 	NL80211_ATTR_EPCS,
3485 
3486 	NL80211_ATTR_ASSOC_MLD_EXT_CAPA_OPS,
3487 
3488 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RADIO_INDEX,
3489 
3490 	NL80211_ATTR_S1G_LONG_BEACON_PERIOD,
3491 	NL80211_ATTR_S1G_SHORT_BEACON,
3492 
3493 	/* add attributes here, update the policy in nl80211.c */
3494 
3495 	__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3496 	NUM_NL80211_ATTR = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3497 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3498 };
3499 
3500 /* source-level API compatibility */
3501 #define NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_GENERATION NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION
3502 #define	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG
3503 #define NL80211_ATTR_IFACE_SOCKET_OWNER NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER
3504 #define NL80211_ATTR_SAE_DATA NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA
3505 #define NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_BEACON NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON
3506 #define NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_PRESP NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP
3507 
3508 /*
3509  * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new attributes by defining them
3510  * here
3511  */
3512 #define NL80211_CMD_CONNECT NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
3513 #define NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY
3514 #define NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES
3515 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS
3516 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
3517 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE
3518 #define NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE
3519 #define NL80211_ATTR_IE NL80211_ATTR_IE
3520 #define NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR
3521 #define NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE
3522 #define NL80211_ATTR_FRAME NL80211_ATTR_FRAME
3523 #define NL80211_ATTR_SSID NL80211_ATTR_SSID
3524 #define NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE
3525 #define NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE
3526 #define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE
3527 #define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP
3528 #define NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS
3529 #define NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES
3530 #define NL80211_ATTR_KEY NL80211_ATTR_KEY
3531 #define NL80211_ATTR_KEYS NL80211_ATTR_KEYS
3532 #define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS
3533 
3534 #define NL80211_WIPHY_NAME_MAXLEN		64
3535 
3536 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES			32
3537 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_SELECTORS		128
3538 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_HT_RATES		77
3539 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_REG_RULES		128
3540 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_ENCR_KEY	0
3541 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_TX_MIC_KEY	16
3542 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_RX_MIC_KEY	24
3543 #define NL80211_HT_CAPABILITY_LEN		26
3544 #define NL80211_VHT_CAPABILITY_LEN		12
3545 #define NL80211_HE_MIN_CAPABILITY_LEN           16
3546 #define NL80211_HE_MAX_CAPABILITY_LEN           54
3547 #define NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES		5
3548 
3549 /*
3550  * NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES is obsolete when %NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES
3551  * present in %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY response.
3552  */
3553 #define NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES		2
3554 #define NL80211_EHT_MIN_CAPABILITY_LEN          13
3555 #define NL80211_EHT_MAX_CAPABILITY_LEN          51
3556 
3557 #define NL80211_MIN_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_TIME	10
3558 
3559 /* default RSSI threshold for scan results if none specified. */
3560 #define NL80211_SCAN_RSSI_THOLD_OFF		-300
3561 
3562 #define NL80211_CQM_TXE_MAX_INTVL		1800
3563 
3564 /**
3565  * enum nl80211_iftype - (virtual) interface types
3566  *
3567  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified type, driver decides
3568  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC: independent BSS member
3569  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION: managed BSS member
3570  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP: access point
3571  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN: VLAN interface for access points; VLAN interfaces
3572  *	are a bit special in that they must always be tied to a pre-existing
3573  *	AP type interface.
3574  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS: wireless distribution interface
3575  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR: monitor interface receiving all frames
3576  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT: mesh point
3577  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT: P2P client
3578  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO: P2P group owner
3579  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE: P2P device interface type, this is not a netdev
3580  *	and therefore can't be created in the normal ways, use the
3581  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE and %NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE
3582  *	commands to create and destroy one
3583  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_OCB: Outside Context of a BSS
3584  *	This mode corresponds to the MIB variable dot11OCBActivated=true
3585  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN: NAN device interface type (not a netdev)
3586  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX: highest interface type number currently defined
3587  * @NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES: number of defined interface types
3588  *
3589  * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE
3590  * to set the type of an interface.
3591  *
3592  */
3593 enum nl80211_iftype {
3594 	NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED,
3595 	NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC,
3596 	NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION,
3597 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AP,
3598 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN,
3599 	NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS,
3600 	NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR,
3601 	NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT,
3602 	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT,
3603 	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO,
3604 	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE,
3605 	NL80211_IFTYPE_OCB,
3606 	NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN,
3607 
3608 	/* keep last */
3609 	NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES,
3610 	NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES - 1
3611 };
3612 
3613 /**
3614  * enum nl80211_sta_flags - station flags
3615  *
3616  * Station flags. When a station is added to an AP interface, it is
3617  * assumed to be already associated (and hence authenticated.)
3618  *
3619  * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3620  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
3621  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE: station is capable of receiving frames
3622  *	with short barker preamble
3623  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME: station is WME/QoS capable
3624  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP: station uses management frame protection
3625  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED: station is authenticated
3626  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER: station is a TDLS peer -- this flag should
3627  *	only be used in managed mode (even in the flags mask). Note that the
3628  *	flag can't be changed, it is only valid while adding a station, and
3629  *	attempts to change it will silently be ignored (rather than rejected
3630  *	as errors.)
3631  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED: station is associated; used with drivers
3632  *	that support %NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE to transition a
3633  *	previously added station into associated state
3634  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU: station supports SPP A-MSDUs
3635  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX: highest station flag number currently defined
3636  * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3637  */
3638 enum nl80211_sta_flags {
3639 	__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID,
3640 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED,
3641 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
3642 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME,
3643 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP,
3644 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED,
3645 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER,
3646 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED,
3647 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU,
3648 
3649 	/* keep last */
3650 	__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST,
3651 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1
3652 };
3653 
3654 /**
3655  * enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status - station support of P2P PS
3656  *
3657  * @NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED: station doesn't support P2P PS mechanism
3658  * @NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED: station supports P2P PS mechanism
3659  * @NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS: number of values
3660  */
3661 enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status {
3662 	NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED = 0,
3663 	NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED,
3664 
3665 	NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS,
3666 };
3667 
3668 #define NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX_OLD_API	NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER
3669 
3670 /**
3671  * struct nl80211_sta_flag_update - station flags mask/set
3672  * @mask: mask of station flags to set
3673  * @set: which values to set them to
3674  *
3675  * Both mask and set contain bits as per &enum nl80211_sta_flags.
3676  */
3677 struct nl80211_sta_flag_update {
3678 	__u32 mask;
3679 	__u32 set;
3680 } __attribute__((packed));
3681 
3682 /**
3683  * enum nl80211_he_gi - HE guard interval
3684  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8: 0.8 usec
3685  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6: 1.6 usec
3686  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2: 3.2 usec
3687  */
3688 enum nl80211_he_gi {
3689 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8,
3690 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6,
3691 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2,
3692 };
3693 
3694 /**
3695  * enum nl80211_he_ltf - HE long training field
3696  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_1XLTF: 3.2 usec
3697  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_2XLTF: 6.4 usec
3698  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_4XLTF: 12.8 usec
3699  */
3700 enum nl80211_he_ltf {
3701 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_1XLTF,
3702 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_2XLTF,
3703 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_4XLTF,
3704 };
3705 
3706 /**
3707  * enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc - HE RU allocation values
3708  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26: 26-tone RU allocation
3709  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52: 52-tone RU allocation
3710  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106: 106-tone RU allocation
3711  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242: 242-tone RU allocation
3712  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484: 484-tone RU allocation
3713  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996: 996-tone RU allocation
3714  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996: 2x996-tone RU allocation
3715  */
3716 enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc {
3717 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26,
3718 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52,
3719 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106,
3720 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242,
3721 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484,
3722 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996,
3723 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996,
3724 };
3725 
3726 /**
3727  * enum nl80211_eht_gi - EHT guard interval
3728  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_0_8: 0.8 usec
3729  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_1_6: 1.6 usec
3730  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_3_2: 3.2 usec
3731  */
3732 enum nl80211_eht_gi {
3733 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_0_8,
3734 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_1_6,
3735 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_3_2,
3736 };
3737 
3738 /**
3739  * enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc - EHT RU allocation values
3740  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_26: 26-tone RU allocation
3741  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52: 52-tone RU allocation
3742  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52P26: 52+26-tone RU allocation
3743  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106: 106-tone RU allocation
3744  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106P26: 106+26 tone RU allocation
3745  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_242: 242-tone RU allocation
3746  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484: 484-tone RU allocation
3747  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484P242: 484+242 tone RU allocation
3748  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996: 996-tone RU allocation
3749  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484: 996+484 tone RU allocation
3750  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484P242: 996+484+242 tone RU allocation
3751  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996: 2x996-tone RU allocation
3752  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996P484: 2x996+484 tone RU allocation
3753  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996: 3x996-tone RU allocation
3754  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996P484: 3x996+484 tone RU allocation
3755  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_4x996: 4x996-tone RU allocation
3756  */
3757 enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc {
3758 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_26,
3759 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52,
3760 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52P26,
3761 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106,
3762 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106P26,
3763 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_242,
3764 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484,
3765 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484P242,
3766 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996,
3767 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484,
3768 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484P242,
3769 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996,
3770 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996P484,
3771 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996,
3772 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996P484,
3773 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_4x996,
3774 };
3775 
3776 /**
3777  * enum nl80211_rate_info - bitrate information
3778  *
3779  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_TXRATE
3780  * when getting information about the bitrate of a station.
3781  * There are 2 attributes for bitrate, a legacy one that represents
3782  * a 16-bit value, and new one that represents a 32-bit value.
3783  * If the rate value fits into 16 bit, both attributes are reported
3784  * with the same value. If the rate is too high to fit into 16 bits
3785  * (>6.5535Gbps) only 32-bit attribute is included.
3786  * User space tools encouraged to use the 32-bit attribute and fall
3787  * back to the 16-bit one for compatibility with older kernels.
3788  *
3789  * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3790  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE: total bitrate (u16, 100kbit/s)
3791  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS: mcs index for 802.11n (u8)
3792  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH: 40 MHz dualchannel bitrate
3793  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
3794  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32: total bitrate (u32, 100kbit/s)
3795  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX: highest rate_info number currently defined
3796  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS: MCS index for VHT (u8)
3797  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS: number of streams in VHT (u8)
3798  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH: 80 MHz VHT rate
3799  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH: unused - 80+80 is treated the
3800  *	same as 160 for purposes of the bitrates
3801  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH: 160 MHz VHT rate
3802  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH: 10 MHz width - note that this is
3803  *	a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e.
3804  *	half the base (20 MHz) rate
3805  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH: 5 MHz width - note that this is
3806  *	a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e.
3807  *	a quarter of the base (20 MHz) rate
3808  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS: HE MCS index (u8, 0-11)
3809  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS: HE NSS value (u8, 1-8)
3810  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI: HE guard interval identifier
3811  *	(u8, see &enum nl80211_he_gi)
3812  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM: HE DCM value (u8, 0/1)
3813  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC: HE RU allocation, if not present then
3814  *	non-OFDMA was used (u8, see &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc)
3815  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_320_MHZ_WIDTH: 320 MHz bitrate
3816  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_MCS: EHT MCS index (u8, 0-15)
3817  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_NSS: EHT NSS value (u8, 1-8)
3818  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI: EHT guard interval identifier
3819  *	(u8, see &enum nl80211_eht_gi)
3820  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC: EHT RU allocation, if not present then
3821  *	non-OFDMA was used (u8, see &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc)
3822  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_MCS: S1G MCS index (u8, 0-10)
3823  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_NSS: S1G NSS value (u8, 1-4)
3824  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_1_MHZ_WIDTH: 1 MHz S1G rate
3825  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_2_MHZ_WIDTH: 2 MHz S1G rate
3826  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_4_MHZ_WIDTH: 4 MHz S1G rate
3827  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_8_MHZ_WIDTH: 8 MHz S1G rate
3828  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_16_MHZ_WIDTH: 16 MHz S1G rate
3829  * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3830  */
3831 enum nl80211_rate_info {
3832 	__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID,
3833 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE,
3834 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS,
3835 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH,
3836 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI,
3837 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32,
3838 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS,
3839 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS,
3840 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH,
3841 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH,
3842 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH,
3843 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH,
3844 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH,
3845 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS,
3846 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS,
3847 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI,
3848 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM,
3849 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC,
3850 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_320_MHZ_WIDTH,
3851 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_MCS,
3852 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_NSS,
3853 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI,
3854 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC,
3855 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_MCS,
3856 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_NSS,
3857 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_1_MHZ_WIDTH,
3858 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_2_MHZ_WIDTH,
3859 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_4_MHZ_WIDTH,
3860 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_8_MHZ_WIDTH,
3861 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_16_MHZ_WIDTH,
3862 
3863 	/* keep last */
3864 	__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3865 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3866 };
3867 
3868 /**
3869  * enum nl80211_sta_bss_param - BSS information collected by STA
3870  *
3871  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM
3872  * when getting information about the bitrate of a station.
3873  *
3874  * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3875  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (flag)
3876  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE:  whether short preamble is enabled
3877  *	(flag)
3878  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME:  whether short slot time is enabled
3879  *	(flag)
3880  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing (u8)
3881  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL: Beacon interval (u16)
3882  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX: highest sta_bss_param number currently defined
3883  * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3884  */
3885 enum nl80211_sta_bss_param {
3886 	__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID,
3887 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT,
3888 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
3889 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME,
3890 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD,
3891 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL,
3892 
3893 	/* keep last */
3894 	__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST,
3895 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX = __NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST - 1
3896 };
3897 
3898 /**
3899  * enum nl80211_sta_info - station information
3900  *
3901  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO
3902  * when getting information about a station.
3903  *
3904  * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3905  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME: time since last activity (u32, msecs)
3906  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES: total received bytes (MPDU length)
3907  *	(u32, from this station)
3908  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length)
3909  *	(u32, to this station)
3910  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64: total received bytes (MPDU length)
3911  *	(u64, from this station)
3912  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length)
3913  *	(u64, to this station)
3914  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL: signal strength of last received PPDU (u8, dBm)
3915  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE: current unicast tx rate, nested attribute
3916  *	containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_rate_info
3917  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS: total received packet (MSDUs and MMPDUs)
3918  *	(u32, from this station)
3919  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS: total transmitted packets (MSDUs and MMPDUs)
3920  *	(u32, to this station)
3921  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES: total retries (MPDUs) (u32, to this station)
3922  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED: total failed packets (MPDUs)
3923  *	(u32, to this station)
3924  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average (u8, dBm)
3925  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID: the station's mesh LLID
3926  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID: the station's mesh PLID
3927  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE: peer link state for the station
3928  *	(see %enum nl80211_plink_state)
3929  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE: last unicast data frame rx rate, nested
3930  *	attribute, like NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE.
3931  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM: current station's view of BSS, nested attribute
3932  *     containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_bss_param
3933  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME: time since the station is last connected
3934  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS: Contains a struct nl80211_sta_flag_update.
3935  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS: count of times beacon loss was detected (u32)
3936  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET: timing offset with respect to this STA (s64)
3937  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM: local mesh STA link-specific power mode
3938  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM: peer mesh STA link-specific power mode
3939  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM: neighbor mesh STA power save mode towards
3940  *	non-peer STA
3941  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last PPDU
3942  *	Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm)
3943  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG: per-chain signal strength average
3944  *	Same format as NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL.
3945  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT: expected throughput considering also
3946  *	the 802.11 header (u32, kbps)
3947  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC: RX packets dropped for unspecified reasons
3948  *	(u64)
3949  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX: number of beacons received from this peer (u64)
3950  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average
3951  *	for beacons only (u8, dBm)
3952  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS: per-TID statistics (see &enum nl80211_tid_stats)
3953  *	This is a nested attribute where each the inner attribute number is the
3954  *	TID+1 and the special TID 16 (i.e. value 17) is used for non-QoS frames;
3955  *	each one of those is again nested with &enum nl80211_tid_stats
3956  *	attributes carrying the actual values.
3957  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames
3958  *	received from the station (u64, usec)
3959  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
3960  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL: signal strength of the last ACK frame(u8, dBm)
3961  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG: avg signal strength of ACK frames (s8, dBm)
3962  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS: total number of received packets (MPDUs)
3963  *	(u32, from this station)
3964  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT: total number of packets (MPDUs) received
3965  *	with an FCS error (u32, from this station). This count may not include
3966  *	some packets with an FCS error due to TA corruption. Hence this counter
3967  *	might not be fully accurate.
3968  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: set to true if STA has a path to a
3969  *	mesh gate (u8, 0 or 1)
3970  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames
3971  *	sent to the station (u64, usec)
3972  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: current airtime weight for station (u16)
3973  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC: airtime link metric for mesh station
3974  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME: Timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME, nanoseconds)
3975  *	of STA's association
3976  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_AS: set to true if STA has a path to a
3977  *	authentication server (u8, 0 or 1)
3978  * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal
3979  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX: highest possible station info attribute
3980  */
3981 enum nl80211_sta_info {
3982 	__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID,
3983 	NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME,
3984 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES,
3985 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES,
3986 	NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID,
3987 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID,
3988 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE,
3989 	NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL,
3990 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE,
3991 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS,
3992 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS,
3993 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES,
3994 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED,
3995 	NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG,
3996 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE,
3997 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM,
3998 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME,
3999 	NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS,
4000 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS,
4001 	NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET,
4002 	NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM,
4003 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM,
4004 	NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM,
4005 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64,
4006 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64,
4007 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL,
4008 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG,
4009 	NL80211_STA_INFO_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT,
4010 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC,
4011 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX,
4012 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG,
4013 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS,
4014 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION,
4015 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD,
4016 	NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL,
4017 	NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG,
4018 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS,
4019 	NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT,
4020 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE,
4021 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION,
4022 	NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT,
4023 	NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC,
4024 	NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME,
4025 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_AS,
4026 
4027 	/* keep last */
4028 	__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
4029 	NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
4030 };
4031 
4032 /* we renamed this - stay compatible */
4033 #define NL80211_STA_INFO_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG
4034 
4035 
4036 /**
4037  * enum nl80211_tid_stats - per TID statistics attributes
4038  * @__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4039  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU: number of MSDUs received (u64)
4040  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU: number of MSDUs transmitted (or
4041  *	attempted to transmit; u64)
4042  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES: number of retries for
4043  *	transmitted MSDUs (not counting the first attempt; u64)
4044  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED: number of failed transmitted
4045  *	MSDUs (u64)
4046  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
4047  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS: TXQ stats (nested attribute)
4048  * @NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS: number of attributes here
4049  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here
4050  */
4051 enum nl80211_tid_stats {
4052 	__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID,
4053 	NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU,
4054 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU,
4055 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES,
4056 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED,
4057 	NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD,
4058 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS,
4059 
4060 	/* keep last */
4061 	NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS,
4062 	NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS - 1
4063 };
4064 
4065 /**
4066  * enum nl80211_txq_stats - per TXQ statistics attributes
4067  * @__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4068  * @NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS: number of attributes here
4069  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES: number of bytes currently backlogged
4070  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS: number of packets currently
4071  *      backlogged
4072  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS: total number of new flows seen
4073  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS: total number of packet drops
4074  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS: total number of packet ECN marks
4075  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT: number of drops due to queue space overflow
4076  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
4077  *      (only for per-phy stats)
4078  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS: number of hash collisions
4079  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES: total number of bytes dequeued from TXQ
4080  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS: total number of packets dequeued from TXQ
4081  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS: number of flow buckets for PHY
4082  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here
4083  */
4084 enum nl80211_txq_stats {
4085 	__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID,
4086 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES,
4087 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS,
4088 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS,
4089 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS,
4090 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS,
4091 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT,
4092 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY,
4093 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS,
4094 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES,
4095 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS,
4096 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS,
4097 
4098 	/* keep last */
4099 	NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS,
4100 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS - 1
4101 };
4102 
4103 /**
4104  * enum nl80211_mpath_flags - nl80211 mesh path flags
4105  *
4106  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE: the mesh path is active
4107  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING: the mesh path discovery process is running
4108  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID: the mesh path contains a valid SN
4109  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED: the mesh path has been manually set
4110  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED: the mesh path discovery process succeeded
4111  */
4112 enum nl80211_mpath_flags {
4113 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE =	1<<0,
4114 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING =	1<<1,
4115 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID =	1<<2,
4116 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED =	1<<3,
4117 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED =	1<<4,
4118 };
4119 
4120 /**
4121  * enum nl80211_mpath_info - mesh path information
4122  *
4123  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO when getting
4124  * information about a mesh path.
4125  *
4126  * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4127  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: number of queued frames for this destination
4128  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN: destination sequence number
4129  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC: metric (cost) of this mesh path
4130  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: expiration time for the path, in msec from now
4131  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: mesh path flags, enumerated in
4132  *	&enum nl80211_mpath_flags;
4133  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: total path discovery timeout, in msec
4134  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: mesh path discovery retries
4135  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: hop count to destination
4136  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: total number of path changes to destination
4137  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX: highest mesh path information attribute number
4138  *	currently defined
4139  * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4140  */
4141 enum nl80211_mpath_info {
4142 	__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID,
4143 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN,
4144 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN,
4145 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC,
4146 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME,
4147 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS,
4148 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT,
4149 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES,
4150 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT,
4151 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE,
4152 
4153 	/* keep last */
4154 	__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
4155 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
4156 };
4157 
4158 /**
4159  * enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr - Interface type data attributes
4160  *
4161  * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4162  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag attribute
4163  *     for each interface type that supports the band data
4164  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC: HE MAC capabilities as in HE
4165  *     capabilities IE
4166  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY: HE PHY capabilities as in HE
4167  *     capabilities IE
4168  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET: HE supported NSS/MCS as in HE
4169  *     capabilities IE
4170  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE: HE PPE thresholds information as
4171  *     defined in HE capabilities IE
4172  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPA: HE 6GHz band capabilities (__le16),
4173  *	given for all 6 GHz band channels
4174  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_VENDOR_ELEMS: vendor element capabilities that are
4175  *	advertised on this band/for this iftype (binary)
4176  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MAC: EHT MAC capabilities as in EHT
4177  *	capabilities element
4178  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PHY: EHT PHY capabilities as in EHT
4179  *	capabilities element
4180  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MCS_SET: EHT supported NSS/MCS as in EHT
4181  *	capabilities element
4182  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PPE: EHT PPE thresholds information as
4183  *	defined in EHT capabilities element
4184  * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4185  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX: highest band attribute currently defined
4186  */
4187 enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr {
4188 	__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID,
4189 
4190 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES,
4191 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC,
4192 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY,
4193 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET,
4194 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE,
4195 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPA,
4196 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_VENDOR_ELEMS,
4197 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MAC,
4198 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PHY,
4199 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MCS_SET,
4200 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PPE,
4201 
4202 	/* keep last */
4203 	__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4204 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4205 };
4206 
4207 /**
4208  * enum nl80211_band_attr - band attributes
4209  * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4210  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS: supported frequencies in this band,
4211  *	an array of nested frequency attributes
4212  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES: supported bitrates in this band,
4213  *	an array of nested bitrate attributes
4214  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET: 16-byte attribute containing the MCS set as
4215  *	defined in 802.11n
4216  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA: HT capabilities, as in the HT information IE
4217  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR: A-MPDU factor, as in 11n
4218  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY: A-MPDU density, as in 11n
4219  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET: 32-byte attribute containing the MCS set as
4220  *	defined in 802.11ac
4221  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA: VHT capabilities, as in the HT information IE
4222  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA: nested array attribute, with each entry using
4223  *	attributes from &enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr
4224  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz
4225  *	channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions.
4226  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251.
4227  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
4228  *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations.
4229  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13.
4230  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_MCS_NSS_SET: S1G capabilities, supported S1G-MCS and NSS
4231  *	set subfield, as in the S1G information IE, 5 bytes
4232  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_CAPA: S1G capabilities information subfield as in the
4233  *	S1G information IE, 10 bytes
4234  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX: highest band attribute currently defined
4235  * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4236  */
4237 enum nl80211_band_attr {
4238 	__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID,
4239 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS,
4240 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES,
4241 
4242 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET,
4243 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA,
4244 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR,
4245 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY,
4246 
4247 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET,
4248 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA,
4249 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA,
4250 
4251 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS,
4252 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG,
4253 
4254 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_MCS_NSS_SET,
4255 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_CAPA,
4256 
4257 	/* keep last */
4258 	__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4259 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4260 };
4261 
4262 #define NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA
4263 
4264 /**
4265  * enum nl80211_wmm_rule - regulatory wmm rule
4266  *
4267  * @__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4268  * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN: Minimum contention window slot.
4269  * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX: Maximum contention window slot.
4270  * @NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN: Arbitration Inter Frame Space.
4271  * @NL80211_WMMR_TXOP: Maximum allowed tx operation time.
4272  * @NL80211_WMMR_MAX: highest possible wmm rule.
4273  * @__NL80211_WMMR_LAST: Internal use.
4274  */
4275 enum nl80211_wmm_rule {
4276 	__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID,
4277 	NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN,
4278 	NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX,
4279 	NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN,
4280 	NL80211_WMMR_TXOP,
4281 
4282 	/* keep last */
4283 	__NL80211_WMMR_LAST,
4284 	NL80211_WMMR_MAX = __NL80211_WMMR_LAST - 1
4285 };
4286 
4287 /**
4288  * enum nl80211_frequency_attr - frequency attributes
4289  * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4290  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ: Frequency in MHz
4291  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED: Channel is disabled in current
4292  *	regulatory domain.
4293  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation
4294  *	are permitted on this channel, this includes sending probe
4295  *	requests, or modes of operation that require beaconing.
4296  * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS: obsolete, same as _NO_IR
4297  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR: Radar detection is mandatory
4298  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4299  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER: Maximum transmission power in mBm
4300  *	(100 * dBm).
4301  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE: current state for DFS
4302  *	(enum nl80211_dfs_state)
4303  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME: time in milliseconds for how long
4304  *	this channel is in this DFS state.
4305  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS: HT40- isn't possible with this
4306  *	channel as the control channel
4307  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS: HT40+ isn't possible with this
4308  *	channel as the control channel
4309  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ: any 80 MHz channel using this channel
4310  *	as the primary or any of the secondary channels isn't possible,
4311  *	this includes 80+80 channels
4312  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ: any 160 MHz (but not 80+80) channel
4313  *	using this channel as the primary or any of the secondary channels
4314  *	isn't possible
4315  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds.
4316  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY: Only indoor use is permitted on this
4317  *	channel. A channel that has the INDOOR_ONLY attribute can only be
4318  *	used when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating in
4319  *	an indoor surroundings, i.e., it is connected to AC power (and not
4320  *	through portable DC inverters) or is under the control of a master
4321  *	that is acting as an AP and is connected to AC power.
4322  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT: IR operation is allowed on this
4323  *	channel if it's connected concurrently to a BSS on the same channel on
4324  *	the 2 GHz band or to a channel in the same UNII band (on the 5 GHz
4325  *	band), and IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR is not set. Instantiating a GO or TDLS
4326  *	off-channel on a channel that has the IR_CONCURRENT attribute set can be
4327  *	done when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating under
4328  *	the guidance of an authorized master, i.e., setting up a GO or TDLS
4329  *	off-channel while the device is also connected to an AP with DFS and
4330  *	radar detection on the UNII band (it is up to user-space, i.e.,
4331  *	wpa_supplicant to perform the required verifications). Using this
4332  *	attribute for IR is disallowed for master interfaces (IBSS, AP).
4333  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz operation is not allowed
4334  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4335  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz operation is not allowed
4336  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4337  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM: this channel has wmm limitations.
4338  *	This is a nested attribute that contains the wmm limitation per AC.
4339  *	(see &enum nl80211_wmm_rule)
4340  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE: HE operation is not allowed on this channel
4341  *	in current regulatory domain.
4342  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_OFFSET: frequency offset in KHz
4343  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_1MHZ: 1 MHz operation is allowed
4344  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4345  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_2MHZ: 2 MHz operation is allowed
4346  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4347  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_4MHZ: 4 MHz operation is allowed
4348  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4349  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_8MHZ: 8 MHz operation is allowed
4350  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4351  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_16MHZ: 16 MHz operation is allowed
4352  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4353  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_320MHZ: any 320 MHz channel using this channel
4354  *	as the primary or any of the secondary channels isn't possible
4355  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_EHT: EHT operation is not allowed on this channel
4356  *	in current regulatory domain.
4357  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PSD: Power spectral density (in dBm) that
4358  *	is allowed on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4359  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CONCURRENT: Operation on this channel is
4360  *	allowed for peer-to-peer or adhoc communication under the control
4361  *	of a DFS master which operates on the same channel (FCC-594280 D01
4362  *	Section B.3). Should be used together with %NL80211_RRF_DFS only.
4363  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT: Client connection to VLP AP
4364  *	not allowed using this channel
4365  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT: Client connection to AFC AP
4366  *	not allowed using this channel
4367  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_CAN_MONITOR: This channel can be used in monitor
4368  *	mode despite other (regulatory) restrictions, even if the channel is
4369  *	otherwise completely disabled.
4370  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_ALLOW_6GHZ_VLP_AP: This channel can be used for a
4371  *	very low power (VLP) AP, despite being NO_IR.
4372  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_ALLOW_20MHZ_ACTIVITY: This channel can be active in
4373  *	20 MHz bandwidth, despite being NO_IR.
4374  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX: highest frequency attribute number
4375  *	currently defined
4376  * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4377  *
4378  * See https://apps.fcc.gov/eas/comments/GetPublishedDocument.html?id=327&tn=528122
4379  * for more information on the FCC description of the relaxations allowed
4380  * by NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY and
4381  * NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT.
4382  */
4383 enum nl80211_frequency_attr {
4384 	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID,
4385 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ,
4386 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED,
4387 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR,
4388 	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS,
4389 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR,
4390 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER,
4391 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE,
4392 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME,
4393 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS,
4394 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS,
4395 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ,
4396 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ,
4397 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME,
4398 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY,
4399 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT,
4400 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ,
4401 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ,
4402 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM,
4403 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE,
4404 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_OFFSET,
4405 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_1MHZ,
4406 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_2MHZ,
4407 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_4MHZ,
4408 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_8MHZ,
4409 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_16MHZ,
4410 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_320MHZ,
4411 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_EHT,
4412 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PSD,
4413 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CONCURRENT,
4414 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT,
4415 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT,
4416 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_CAN_MONITOR,
4417 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_ALLOW_6GHZ_VLP_AP,
4418 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_ALLOW_20MHZ_ACTIVITY,
4419 
4420 	/* keep last */
4421 	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4422 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4423 };
4424 
4425 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER
4426 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PASSIVE_SCAN	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
4427 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS		NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
4428 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR		NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
4429 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_GO_CONCURRENT \
4430 					NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
4431 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_UHB_VLP_CLIENT \
4432 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT
4433 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_UHB_AFC_CLIENT \
4434 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT
4435 
4436 /**
4437  * enum nl80211_bitrate_attr - bitrate attributes
4438  * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4439  * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE: Bitrate in units of 100 kbps
4440  * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE: Short preamble supported
4441  *	in 2.4 GHz band.
4442  * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX: highest bitrate attribute number
4443  *	currently defined
4444  * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4445  */
4446 enum nl80211_bitrate_attr {
4447 	__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID,
4448 	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE,
4449 	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE,
4450 
4451 	/* keep last */
4452 	__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4453 	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4454 };
4455 
4456 /**
4457  * enum nl80211_reg_initiator - Indicates the initiator of a reg domain request
4458  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE: Core queried CRDA for a dynamic world
4459  *	regulatory domain.
4460  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER: User asked the wireless core to set the
4461  *	regulatory domain.
4462  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER: a wireless drivers has hinted to the
4463  *	wireless core it thinks its knows the regulatory domain we should be in.
4464  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE: the wireless core has received an
4465  *	802.11 country information element with regulatory information it
4466  *	thinks we should consider. cfg80211 only processes the country
4467  *	code from the IE, and relies on the regulatory domain information
4468  *	structure passed by userspace (CRDA) from our wireless-regdb.
4469  *	If a channel is enabled but the country code indicates it should
4470  *	be disabled we disable the channel and re-enable it upon disassociation.
4471  */
4472 enum nl80211_reg_initiator {
4473 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE,
4474 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER,
4475 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER,
4476 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE,
4477 };
4478 
4479 /**
4480  * enum nl80211_reg_type - specifies the type of regulatory domain
4481  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY: the regulatory domain set is one that pertains
4482  *	to a specific country. When this is set you can count on the
4483  *	ISO / IEC 3166 alpha2 country code being valid.
4484  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD: the regulatory set domain is the world regulatory
4485  *	domain.
4486  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD: the regulatory domain set is a custom
4487  *	driver specific world regulatory domain. These do not apply system-wide
4488  *	and are only applicable to the individual devices which have requested
4489  *	them to be applied.
4490  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION: the regulatory domain set is the product
4491  *	of an intersection between two regulatory domains -- the previously
4492  *	set regulatory domain on the system and the last accepted regulatory
4493  *	domain request to be processed.
4494  */
4495 enum nl80211_reg_type {
4496 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY,
4497 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD,
4498 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD,
4499 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION,
4500 };
4501 
4502 /**
4503  * enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr - regulatory rule attributes
4504  * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4505  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS: a set of flags which specify additional
4506  *	considerations for a given frequency range. These are the
4507  *	&enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags.
4508  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START: starting frequencry for the regulatory
4509  *	rule in KHz. This is not a center of frequency but an actual regulatory
4510  *	band edge.
4511  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END: ending frequency for the regulatory rule
4512  *	in KHz. This is not a center a frequency but an actual regulatory
4513  *	band edge.
4514  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW: maximum allowed bandwidth for this
4515  *	frequency range, in KHz.
4516  * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN: the maximum allowed antenna gain
4517  *	for a given frequency range. The value is in mBi (100 * dBi).
4518  *	If you don't have one then don't send this.
4519  * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP: the maximum allowed EIRP for
4520  *	a given frequency range. The value is in mBm (100 * dBm).
4521  * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds.
4522  *	If not present or 0 default CAC time will be used.
4523  * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_PSD: power spectral density (in dBm).
4524  *	This could be negative.
4525  * @NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX: highest regulatory rule attribute number
4526  *	currently defined
4527  * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4528  */
4529 enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr {
4530 	__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID,
4531 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS,
4532 
4533 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START,
4534 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END,
4535 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW,
4536 
4537 	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN,
4538 	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP,
4539 
4540 	NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME,
4541 
4542 	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_PSD,
4543 
4544 	/* keep last */
4545 	__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4546 	NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4547 };
4548 
4549 /**
4550  * enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr - scheduled scan match attributes
4551  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4552  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID: SSID to be used for matching,
4553  *	only report BSS with matching SSID.
4554  *	(This cannot be used together with BSSID.)
4555  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI: RSSI threshold (in dBm) for reporting a
4556  *	BSS in scan results. Filtering is turned off if not specified. Note that
4557  *	if this attribute is in a match set of its own, then it is treated as
4558  *	the default value for all matchsets with an SSID, rather than being a
4559  *	matchset of its own without an RSSI filter. This is due to problems with
4560  *	how this API was implemented in the past. Also, due to the same problem,
4561  *	the only way to create a matchset with only an RSSI filter (with this
4562  *	attribute) is if there's only a single matchset with the RSSI attribute.
4563  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI: Flag indicating whether
4564  *	%NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI to be used as absolute RSSI or
4565  *	relative to current bss's RSSI.
4566  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for
4567  *	BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
4568  *	RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure
4569  *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
4570  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID: BSSID to be used for matching
4571  *	(this cannot be used together with SSID).
4572  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI: Obsolete
4573  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest scheduled scan filter
4574  *	attribute number currently defined
4575  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4576  */
4577 enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr {
4578 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID,
4579 
4580 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID,
4581 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI,
4582 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI,
4583 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST,
4584 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID,
4585 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI, /* obsolete */
4586 
4587 	/* keep last */
4588 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4589 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX =
4590 		__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4591 };
4592 
4593 /* only for backward compatibility */
4594 #define NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_SSID NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID
4595 
4596 /**
4597  * enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags - regulatory rule flags
4598  *
4599  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM: OFDM modulation not allowed
4600  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK: CCK modulation not allowed
4601  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR: indoor operation not allowed
4602  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR: outdoor operation not allowed
4603  * @NL80211_RRF_DFS: DFS support is required to be used
4604  * @NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Point links
4605  * @NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Multi Point links
4606  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation are allowed,
4607  *	this includes probe requests or modes of operation that require
4608  *	beaconing.
4609  * @__NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS: obsolete, same as NO_IR
4610  * @NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW: maximum available bandwidth should be calculated
4611  *	base on contiguous rules and wider channels will be allowed to cross
4612  *	multiple contiguous/overlapping frequency ranges.
4613  * @NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT: See %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
4614  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS: channels can't be used in HT40- operation
4615  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS: channels can't be used in HT40+ operation
4616  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ: 80MHz operation not allowed
4617  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ: 160MHz operation not allowed
4618  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HE: HE operation not allowed
4619  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_320MHZ: 320MHz operation not allowed
4620  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_EHT: EHT operation not allowed
4621  * @NL80211_RRF_PSD: Ruleset has power spectral density value
4622  * @NL80211_RRF_DFS_CONCURRENT: Operation on this channel is allowed for
4623  *	peer-to-peer or adhoc communication under the control of a DFS master
4624  *	which operates on the same channel (FCC-594280 D01 Section B.3).
4625  *	Should be used together with %NL80211_RRF_DFS only.
4626  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT: Client connection to VLP AP not allowed
4627  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT: Client connection to AFC AP not allowed
4628  * @NL80211_RRF_ALLOW_6GHZ_VLP_AP: Very low power (VLP) AP can be permitted
4629  *	despite NO_IR configuration.
4630  * @NL80211_RRF_ALLOW_20MHZ_ACTIVITY: Allow activity in 20 MHz bandwidth,
4631  *	despite NO_IR configuration.
4632  */
4633 enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags {
4634 	NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM                 = 1 << 0,
4635 	NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK                  = 1 << 1,
4636 	NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR               = 1 << 2,
4637 	NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR              = 1 << 3,
4638 	NL80211_RRF_DFS                     = 1 << 4,
4639 	NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY                = 1 << 5,
4640 	NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY               = 1 << 6,
4641 	NL80211_RRF_NO_IR                   = 1 << 7,
4642 	__NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS               = 1 << 8,
4643 	NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW                 = 1 << 11,
4644 	NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT           = 1 << 12,
4645 	NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS            = 1 << 13,
4646 	NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS             = 1 << 14,
4647 	NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ                = 1 << 15,
4648 	NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ               = 1 << 16,
4649 	NL80211_RRF_NO_HE                   = 1 << 17,
4650 	NL80211_RRF_NO_320MHZ               = 1 << 18,
4651 	NL80211_RRF_NO_EHT                  = 1 << 19,
4652 	NL80211_RRF_PSD                     = 1 << 20,
4653 	NL80211_RRF_DFS_CONCURRENT          = 1 << 21,
4654 	NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT      = 1 << 22,
4655 	NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT      = 1 << 23,
4656 	NL80211_RRF_ALLOW_6GHZ_VLP_AP       = 1 << 24,
4657 	NL80211_RRF_ALLOW_20MHZ_ACTIVITY    = 1 << 25,
4658 };
4659 
4660 #define NL80211_RRF_PASSIVE_SCAN	NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4661 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS		NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4662 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR		NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4663 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40		(NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS |\
4664 					 NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS)
4665 #define NL80211_RRF_GO_CONCURRENT	NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT
4666 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_UHB_VLP_CLIENT	NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT
4667 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_UHB_AFC_CLIENT	NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT
4668 
4669 /* For backport compatibility with older userspace */
4670 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR_ALL		(NL80211_RRF_NO_IR | __NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS)
4671 
4672 /**
4673  * enum nl80211_dfs_regions - regulatory DFS regions
4674  *
4675  * @NL80211_DFS_UNSET: Country has no DFS master region specified
4676  * @NL80211_DFS_FCC: Country follows DFS master rules from FCC
4677  * @NL80211_DFS_ETSI: Country follows DFS master rules from ETSI
4678  * @NL80211_DFS_JP: Country follows DFS master rules from JP/MKK/Telec
4679  */
4680 enum nl80211_dfs_regions {
4681 	NL80211_DFS_UNSET	= 0,
4682 	NL80211_DFS_FCC		= 1,
4683 	NL80211_DFS_ETSI	= 2,
4684 	NL80211_DFS_JP		= 3,
4685 };
4686 
4687 /**
4688  * enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type - type of user regulatory hint
4689  *
4690  * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER: a user sent the hint. This is always
4691  *	assumed if the attribute is not set.
4692  * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE: the hint comes from a cellular
4693  *	base station. Device drivers that have been tested to work
4694  *	properly to support this type of hint can enable these hints
4695  *	by setting the NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS feature
4696  *	capability on the struct wiphy. The wireless core will
4697  *	ignore all cell base station hints until at least one device
4698  *	present has been registered with the wireless core that
4699  *	has listed NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS as a
4700  *	supported feature.
4701  * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR: a user sent an hint indicating that the
4702  *	platform is operating in an indoor environment.
4703  */
4704 enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type {
4705 	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER	= 0,
4706 	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE = 1,
4707 	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR    = 2,
4708 };
4709 
4710 /**
4711  * enum nl80211_survey_info - survey information
4712  *
4713  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO
4714  * when getting information about a survey.
4715  *
4716  * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4717  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY: center frequency of channel
4718  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE: noise level of channel (u8, dBm)
4719  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
4720  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME: amount of time (in ms) that the radio
4721  *	was turned on (on channel or globally)
4722  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: amount of the time the primary
4723  *	channel was sensed busy (either due to activity or energy detect)
4724  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: amount of time the extension
4725  *	channel was sensed busy
4726  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: amount of time the radio spent
4727  *	receiving data (on channel or globally)
4728  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: amount of time the radio spent
4729  *	transmitting data (on channel or globally)
4730  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: time the radio spent for scan
4731  *	(on this channel or globally)
4732  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
4733  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: amount of time the radio spent
4734  *	receiving frames destined to the local BSS
4735  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX: highest survey info attribute number
4736  *	currently defined
4737  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY_OFFSET: center frequency offset in KHz
4738  * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4739  */
4740 enum nl80211_survey_info {
4741 	__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID,
4742 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY,
4743 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE,
4744 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE,
4745 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME,
4746 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY,
4747 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY,
4748 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX,
4749 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX,
4750 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN,
4751 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD,
4752 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX,
4753 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY_OFFSET,
4754 
4755 	/* keep last */
4756 	__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
4757 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
4758 };
4759 
4760 /* keep old names for compatibility */
4761 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME
4762 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_BUSY		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY
4763 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_EXT_BUSY	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY
4764 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_RX		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX
4765 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_TX		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX
4766 
4767 /**
4768  * enum nl80211_mntr_flags - monitor configuration flags
4769  *
4770  * Monitor configuration flags.
4771  *
4772  * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID: reserved
4773  *
4774  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
4775  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
4776  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
4777  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
4778  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: deprecated
4779  *	will unconditionally be refused
4780  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE: use the configured MAC address
4781  *	and ACK incoming unicast packets.
4782  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_SKIP_TX: do not pass local tx packets
4783  *
4784  * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4785  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX: highest possible monitor flag
4786  */
4787 enum nl80211_mntr_flags {
4788 	__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID,
4789 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL,
4790 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL,
4791 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL,
4792 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS,
4793 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES,
4794 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE,
4795 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_SKIP_TX,
4796 
4797 	/* keep last */
4798 	__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST,
4799 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1
4800 };
4801 
4802 /**
4803  * enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode - mesh power save modes
4804  *
4805  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN: The mesh power mode of the mesh STA is
4806  *	not known or has not been set yet.
4807  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE: Active mesh power mode. The mesh STA is
4808  *	in Awake state all the time.
4809  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP: Light sleep mode. The mesh STA will
4810  *	alternate between Active and Doze states, but will wake up for
4811  *	neighbor's beacons.
4812  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP: Deep sleep mode. The mesh STA will
4813  *	alternate between Active and Doze states, but may not wake up
4814  *	for neighbor's beacons.
4815  *
4816  * @__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4817  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX: highest possible power save level
4818  */
4819 
4820 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode {
4821 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN,
4822 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE,
4823 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP,
4824 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP,
4825 
4826 	__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST,
4827 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - 1
4828 };
4829 
4830 /**
4831  * enum nl80211_meshconf_params - mesh configuration parameters
4832  *
4833  * Mesh configuration parameters. These can be changed while the mesh is
4834  * active.
4835  *
4836  * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID: internal use
4837  *
4838  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial retry timeout in
4839  *	millisecond units, used by the Peer Link Open message
4840  *
4841  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial confirm timeout, in
4842  *	millisecond units, used by the peer link management to close a peer link
4843  *
4844  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT: specifies the holding timeout, in
4845  *	millisecond units
4846  *
4847  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS: maximum number of peer links allowed
4848  *	on this mesh interface
4849  *
4850  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES: specifies the maximum number of peer link
4851  *	open retries that can be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a
4852  *	mesh
4853  *
4854  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a source mesh
4855  *	point.
4856  *
4857  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS: whether we should automatically open
4858  *	peer links when we detect compatible mesh peers. Disabled if
4859  *	@NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM or @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE are
4860  *	set.
4861  *
4862  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES: the number of action frames
4863  *	containing a PREQ that an MP can send to a particular destination (path
4864  *	target)
4865  *
4866  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME: how frequently to refresh mesh paths
4867  *	(in milliseconds)
4868  *
4869  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: minimum length of time to wait
4870  *	until giving up on a path discovery (in milliseconds)
4871  *
4872  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for which mesh
4873  *	points receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from
4874  *	the root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
4875  *
4876  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in
4877  *	TUs) during which an MP can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
4878  *	reference element
4879  *
4880  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME: The interval of time (in TUs)
4881  *	that it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the
4882  *	mesh
4883  *
4884  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE: whether root mode is enabled or not
4885  *
4886  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a
4887  *	source mesh point for path selection elements.
4888  *
4889  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL:  The interval of time (in TUs) between
4890  *	root announcements are transmitted.
4891  *
4892  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS: Advertise that this mesh station has
4893  *	access to a broader network beyond the MBSS.  This is done via Root
4894  *	Announcement frames.
4895  *
4896  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in
4897  *	TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a
4898  *	PERR element.
4899  *
4900  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING: set Mesh STA as forwarding or non-forwarding
4901  *	or forwarding entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
4902  *
4903  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This specifies the
4904  *	threshold for average signal strength of candidate station to establish
4905  *	a peer link.
4906  *
4907  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR: maximum number of neighbors
4908  *	to synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
4909  *	(see 11C.12.2.2)
4910  *
4911  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE: set mesh HT protection mode.
4912  *
4913  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh configuration attribute
4914  *
4915  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for
4916  *	which mesh STAs receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding
4917  *	information to the root mesh STA to be valid.
4918  *
4919  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL: The interval of time (in TUs) between
4920  *	proactive PREQs are transmitted.
4921  *
4922  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time
4923  *	(in TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame
4924  *	containing a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
4925  *
4926  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE: Default mesh power mode for new peer links.
4927  *	type &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode (u32)
4928  *
4929  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW: awake window duration (in TUs)
4930  *
4931  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've
4932  *	established peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then
4933  *	remove it from the STA's list of peers. You may set this to 0 to disable
4934  *	the removal of the STA. Default is 30 minutes.
4935  *
4936  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: If set to true then this mesh STA
4937  *	will advertise that it is connected to a gate in the mesh formation
4938  *	field.  If left unset then the mesh formation field will only
4939  *	advertise such if there is an active root mesh path.
4940  *
4941  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_NOLEARN: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g.
4942  *      PREQ/PREP for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that
4943  *      this might not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be
4944  *      better. So if using this setting you will likely also want to disable
4945  *      dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top.
4946  *
4947  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_AS: If set to true then this mesh STA
4948  *	will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server
4949  *	in the mesh formation field.
4950  *
4951  * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4952  */
4953 enum nl80211_meshconf_params {
4954 	__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID,
4955 	NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT,
4956 	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT,
4957 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT,
4958 	NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS,
4959 	NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES,
4960 	NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL,
4961 	NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS,
4962 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES,
4963 	NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME,
4964 	NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT,
4965 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT,
4966 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL,
4967 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME,
4968 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE,
4969 	NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL,
4970 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL,
4971 	NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS,
4972 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL,
4973 	NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING,
4974 	NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD,
4975 	NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR,
4976 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE,
4977 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT,
4978 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL,
4979 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL,
4980 	NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE,
4981 	NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW,
4982 	NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT,
4983 	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE,
4984 	NL80211_MESHCONF_NOLEARN,
4985 	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_AS,
4986 
4987 	/* keep last */
4988 	__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4989 	NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4990 };
4991 
4992 /**
4993  * enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params - mesh setup parameters
4994  *
4995  * Mesh setup parameters.  These are used to start/join a mesh and cannot be
4996  * changed while the mesh is active.
4997  *
4998  * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID: Internal use
4999  *
5000  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL: Enable this option to use a
5001  *	vendor specific path selection algorithm or disable it to use the
5002  *	default HWMP.
5003  *
5004  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC: Enable this option to use a
5005  *	vendor specific path metric or disable it to use the default Airtime
5006  *	metric.
5007  *
5008  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE: Information elements for this mesh, for instance, a
5009  *	robust security network ie, or a vendor specific information element
5010  *	that vendors will use to identify the path selection methods and
5011  *	metrics in use.
5012  *
5013  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH: Enable this option if an authentication
5014  *	daemon will be authenticating mesh candidates.
5015  *
5016  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE: Enable this option if an authentication
5017  *	daemon will be securing peer link frames.  AMPE is a secured version of
5018  *	Mesh Peering Management (MPM) and is implemented with the assistance of
5019  *	a userspace daemon.  When this flag is set, the kernel will send peer
5020  *	management frames to a userspace daemon that will implement AMPE
5021  *	functionality (security capabilities selection, key confirmation, and
5022  *	key management).  When the flag is unset (default), the kernel can
5023  *	autonomously complete (unsecured) mesh peering without the need of a
5024  *	userspace daemon.
5025  *
5026  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC: Enable this option to use a
5027  *	vendor specific synchronization method or disable it to use the default
5028  *	neighbor offset synchronization
5029  *
5030  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM: Enable this option if userspace will
5031  *	implement an MPM which handles peer allocation and state.
5032  *
5033  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL: Inform the kernel of the authentication
5034  *	method (u8, as defined in IEEE 8.4.2.100.6, e.g. 0x1 for SAE).
5035  *	Default is no authentication method required.
5036  *
5037  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh setup attribute number
5038  *
5039  * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal use
5040  */
5041 enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params {
5042 	__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID,
5043 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL,
5044 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC,
5045 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE,
5046 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH,
5047 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE,
5048 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC,
5049 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM,
5050 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL,
5051 
5052 	/* keep last */
5053 	__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
5054 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
5055 };
5056 
5057 /**
5058  * enum nl80211_txq_attr - TX queue parameter attributes
5059  * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID: Attribute number 0 is reserved
5060  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC: AC identifier (NL80211_AC_*)
5061  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning
5062  *	disabled
5063  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN: Minimum contention window [a value of the form
5064  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
5065  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX: Maximum contention window [a value of the form
5066  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
5067  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
5068  * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal
5069  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX: Maximum TXQ attribute number
5070  */
5071 enum nl80211_txq_attr {
5072 	__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID,
5073 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC,
5074 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP,
5075 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN,
5076 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX,
5077 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS,
5078 
5079 	/* keep last */
5080 	__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
5081 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
5082 };
5083 
5084 enum nl80211_ac {
5085 	NL80211_AC_VO,
5086 	NL80211_AC_VI,
5087 	NL80211_AC_BE,
5088 	NL80211_AC_BK,
5089 	NL80211_NUM_ACS
5090 };
5091 
5092 /* backward compat */
5093 #define NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_QUEUE	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC
5094 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VO	NL80211_AC_VO
5095 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VI	NL80211_AC_VI
5096 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BE	NL80211_AC_BE
5097 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BK	NL80211_AC_BK
5098 
5099 /**
5100  * enum nl80211_channel_type - channel type
5101  * @NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel
5102  * @NL80211_CHAN_HT20: 20 MHz HT channel
5103  * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel
5104  *	below the control channel
5105  * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel
5106  *	above the control channel
5107  */
5108 enum nl80211_channel_type {
5109 	NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT,
5110 	NL80211_CHAN_HT20,
5111 	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS,
5112 	NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS
5113 };
5114 
5115 /**
5116  * enum nl80211_key_mode - Key mode
5117  *
5118  * @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX: (Default)
5119  *	Key can be used for Rx and Tx immediately
5120  *
5121  * The following modes can only be selected for unicast keys and when the
5122  * driver supports @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID:
5123  *
5124  * @NL80211_KEY_NO_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY:
5125  *	Unicast key can only be used for Rx, Tx not allowed, yet
5126  * @NL80211_KEY_SET_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY:
5127  *	The unicast key identified by idx and mac is cleared for Tx and becomes
5128  *	the preferred Tx key for the station.
5129  */
5130 enum nl80211_key_mode {
5131 	NL80211_KEY_RX_TX,
5132 	NL80211_KEY_NO_TX,
5133 	NL80211_KEY_SET_TX
5134 };
5135 
5136 /**
5137  * enum nl80211_chan_width - channel width definitions
5138  *
5139  * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH
5140  * attribute.
5141  *
5142  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel
5143  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20: 20 MHz HT channel
5144  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40: 40 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
5145  *	attribute must be provided as well
5146  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80: 80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
5147  *	attribute must be provided as well
5148  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80: 80+80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
5149  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2 attributes must be provided as well
5150  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160: 160 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
5151  *	attribute must be provided as well
5152  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 5 MHz OFDM channel
5153  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 10 MHz OFDM channel
5154  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_1: 1 MHz OFDM channel
5155  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_2: 2 MHz OFDM channel
5156  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_4: 4 MHz OFDM channel
5157  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_8: 8 MHz OFDM channel
5158  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_16: 16 MHz OFDM channel
5159  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320: 320 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
5160  *	attribute must be provided as well
5161  */
5162 enum nl80211_chan_width {
5163 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT,
5164 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
5165 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40,
5166 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80,
5167 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80,
5168 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160,
5169 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5,
5170 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10,
5171 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_1,
5172 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_2,
5173 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_4,
5174 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_8,
5175 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_16,
5176 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320,
5177 };
5178 
5179 /**
5180  * enum nl80211_bss_scan_width - control channel width for a BSS
5181  *
5182  * These values are used with the %NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH attribute.
5183  *
5184  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20: control channel is 20 MHz wide or compatible
5185  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10: control channel is 10 MHz wide
5186  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5: control channel is 5 MHz wide
5187  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_1: control channel is 1 MHz wide
5188  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_2: control channel is 2 MHz wide
5189  */
5190 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width {
5191 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
5192 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10,
5193 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5,
5194 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_1,
5195 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_2,
5196 };
5197 
5198 /**
5199  * enum nl80211_bss_use_for - bitmap indicating possible BSS use
5200  * @NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL: Use this BSS for normal "connection",
5201  *	including IBSS/MBSS depending on the type.
5202  * @NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_MLD_LINK: This BSS can be used as a link in an
5203  *	MLO connection. Note that for an MLO connection, all links including
5204  *	the assoc link must have this flag set, and the assoc link must
5205  *	additionally have %NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL set.
5206  */
5207 enum nl80211_bss_use_for {
5208 	NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL = 1 << 0,
5209 	NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_MLD_LINK = 1 << 1,
5210 };
5211 
5212 /**
5213  * enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons - reason(s) connection to a
5214  *	BSS isn't possible
5215  * @NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_NSTR_NONPRIMARY: NSTR nonprimary links aren't
5216  *	supported by the device, and this BSS entry represents one.
5217  * @NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_6GHZ_PWR_MISMATCH: STA is not supporting
5218  *	the AP power type (SP, VLP, AP) that the AP uses.
5219  */
5220 enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons {
5221 	NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_NSTR_NONPRIMARY	= 1 << 0,
5222 	NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_6GHZ_PWR_MISMATCH	= 1 << 1,
5223 };
5224 
5225 #define NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_UHB_PWR_MISMATCH \
5226 	NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_6GHZ_PWR_MISMATCH
5227 
5228 /**
5229  * enum nl80211_bss - netlink attributes for a BSS
5230  *
5231  * @__NL80211_BSS_INVALID: invalid
5232  * @NL80211_BSS_BSSID: BSSID of the BSS (6 octets)
5233  * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY: frequency in MHz (u32)
5234  * @NL80211_BSS_TSF: TSF of the received probe response/beacon (u64)
5235  *	(if @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA is present then this is known to be
5236  *	from a probe response, otherwise it may be from the same beacon
5237  *	that the NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF will be from)
5238  * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval of the (I)BSS (u16)
5239  * @NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY: capability field (CPU order, u16)
5240  * @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS: binary attribute containing the
5241  *	raw information elements from the probe response/beacon (bin);
5242  *	if the %NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES attribute is present and the data is
5243  *	different then the IEs here are from a Probe Response frame; otherwise
5244  *	they are from a Beacon frame.
5245  *	However, if the driver does not indicate the source of the IEs, these
5246  *	IEs may be from either frame subtype.
5247  *	If present, the @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA attribute indicates that the
5248  *	data here is known to be from a probe response, without any heuristics.
5249  * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM: signal strength of probe response/beacon
5250  *	in mBm (100 * dBm) (s32)
5251  * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC: signal strength of the probe response/beacon
5252  *	in unspecified units, scaled to 0..100 (u8)
5253  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS: status, if this BSS is "used"
5254  * @NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO: age of this BSS entry in ms
5255  * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES: binary attribute containing the raw information
5256  *	elements from a Beacon frame (bin); not present if no Beacon frame has
5257  *	yet been received
5258  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH: channel width of the control channel
5259  *	(u32, enum nl80211_bss_scan_width) - No longer used!
5260  * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF: TSF of the last received beacon (u64)
5261  *	(not present if no beacon frame has been received yet)
5262  * @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA: the data in @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS and
5263  *	@NL80211_BSS_TSF is known to be from a probe response (flag attribute)
5264  * @NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp when this entry
5265  *	was last updated by a received frame. The value is expected to be
5266  *	accurate to about 10ms. (u64, nanoseconds)
5267  * @NL80211_BSS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
5268  * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF: the time at the start of reception of the first
5269  *	octet of the timestamp field of the last beacon/probe received for
5270  *	this BSS. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified by
5271  *	@NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID. (u64).
5272  * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID: the BSS according to which @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF
5273  *	is set.
5274  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last BSS update.
5275  *	Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm),
5276  *	using the nesting index as the antenna number.
5277  * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY_OFFSET: frequency offset in KHz
5278  * @NL80211_BSS_MLO_LINK_ID: MLO link ID of the BSS (u8).
5279  * @NL80211_BSS_MLD_ADDR: MLD address of this BSS if connected to it.
5280  * @NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR: u32 bitmap attribute indicating what the BSS can be
5281  *	used for, see &enum nl80211_bss_use_for.
5282  * @NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_REASONS: Indicates the reason that this BSS cannot
5283  *	be used for all or some of the possible uses by the device reporting it,
5284  *	even though its presence was detected.
5285  *	This is a u64 attribute containing a bitmap of values from
5286  *	&enum nl80211_cannot_use_reasons, note that the attribute may be missing
5287  *	if no reasons are specified.
5288  * @__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST: internal
5289  * @NL80211_BSS_MAX: highest BSS attribute
5290  */
5291 enum nl80211_bss {
5292 	__NL80211_BSS_INVALID,
5293 	NL80211_BSS_BSSID,
5294 	NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY,
5295 	NL80211_BSS_TSF,
5296 	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL,
5297 	NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY,
5298 	NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS,
5299 	NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM,
5300 	NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
5301 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS,
5302 	NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO,
5303 	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES,
5304 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH,
5305 	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF,
5306 	NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA,
5307 	NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME,
5308 	NL80211_BSS_PAD,
5309 	NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF,
5310 	NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID,
5311 	NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL,
5312 	NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY_OFFSET,
5313 	NL80211_BSS_MLO_LINK_ID,
5314 	NL80211_BSS_MLD_ADDR,
5315 	NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR,
5316 	NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_REASONS,
5317 
5318 	/* keep last */
5319 	__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST,
5320 	NL80211_BSS_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST - 1
5321 };
5322 
5323 /**
5324  * enum nl80211_bss_status - BSS "status"
5325  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED: Authenticated with this BSS.
5326  *	Note that this is no longer used since cfg80211 no longer
5327  *	keeps track of whether or not authentication was done with
5328  *	a given BSS.
5329  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED: Associated with this BSS.
5330  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED: Joined to this IBSS.
5331  *
5332  * The BSS status is a BSS attribute in scan dumps, which
5333  * indicates the status the interface has wrt. this BSS.
5334  */
5335 enum nl80211_bss_status {
5336 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED,
5337 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED,
5338 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED,
5339 };
5340 
5341 /**
5342  * enum nl80211_auth_type - AuthenticationType
5343  *
5344  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM: Open System authentication
5345  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY: Shared Key authentication (WEP only)
5346  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT: Fast BSS Transition (IEEE 802.11r)
5347  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP: Network EAP (some Cisco APs and mainly LEAP)
5348  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE: Simultaneous authentication of equals
5349  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key
5350  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key with PFS
5351  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK: Fast Initial Link Setup public key
5352  * @__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM: internal
5353  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX: maximum valid auth algorithm
5354  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC: determine automatically (if necessary by
5355  *	trying multiple times); this is invalid in netlink -- leave out
5356  *	the attribute for this on CONNECT commands.
5357  */
5358 enum nl80211_auth_type {
5359 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM,
5360 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY,
5361 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT,
5362 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP,
5363 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE,
5364 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK,
5365 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS,
5366 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK,
5367 
5368 	/* keep last */
5369 	__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM,
5370 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX = __NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM - 1,
5371 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC
5372 };
5373 
5374 /**
5375  * enum nl80211_key_type - Key Type
5376  * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP: Group (broadcast/multicast) key
5377  * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE: Pairwise (unicast/individual) key
5378  * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY: PeerKey (DLS)
5379  * @NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES: number of defined key types
5380  */
5381 enum nl80211_key_type {
5382 	NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP,
5383 	NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE,
5384 	NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY,
5385 
5386 	NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES
5387 };
5388 
5389 /**
5390  * enum nl80211_mfp - Management frame protection state
5391  * @NL80211_MFP_NO: Management frame protection not used
5392  * @NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED: Management frame protection required
5393  * @NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL: Management frame protection is optional
5394  */
5395 enum nl80211_mfp {
5396 	NL80211_MFP_NO,
5397 	NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED,
5398 	NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL,
5399 };
5400 
5401 enum nl80211_wpa_versions {
5402 	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_1 = 1 << 0,
5403 	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_2 = 1 << 1,
5404 	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_3 = 1 << 2,
5405 };
5406 
5407 /**
5408  * enum nl80211_key_default_types - key default types
5409  * @__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID: invalid
5410  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST: key should be used as default
5411  *	unicast key
5412  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST: key should be used as default
5413  *	multicast key
5414  * @NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: number of default types
5415  */
5416 enum nl80211_key_default_types {
5417 	__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID,
5418 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST,
5419 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST,
5420 
5421 	NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES
5422 };
5423 
5424 /**
5425  * enum nl80211_key_attributes - key attributes
5426  * @__NL80211_KEY_INVALID: invalid
5427  * @NL80211_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of
5428  *	16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC
5429  *	keys
5430  * @NL80211_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3)
5431  * @NL80211_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11
5432  *	section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04)
5433  * @NL80211_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and
5434  *	CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian
5435  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT: flag indicating default key
5436  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: flag indicating default management key
5437  * @NL80211_KEY_TYPE: the key type from enum nl80211_key_type, if not
5438  *	specified the default depends on whether a MAC address was
5439  *	given with the command using the key or not (u32)
5440  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags
5441  *	attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as.
5442  *	See &enum nl80211_key_default_types.
5443  * @NL80211_KEY_MODE: the mode from enum nl80211_key_mode.
5444  *	Defaults to @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX.
5445  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON: flag indicating default Beacon frame key
5446  *
5447  * @__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST: internal
5448  * @NL80211_KEY_MAX: highest key attribute
5449  */
5450 enum nl80211_key_attributes {
5451 	__NL80211_KEY_INVALID,
5452 	NL80211_KEY_DATA,
5453 	NL80211_KEY_IDX,
5454 	NL80211_KEY_CIPHER,
5455 	NL80211_KEY_SEQ,
5456 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT,
5457 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT,
5458 	NL80211_KEY_TYPE,
5459 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES,
5460 	NL80211_KEY_MODE,
5461 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON,
5462 
5463 	/* keep last */
5464 	__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST,
5465 	NL80211_KEY_MAX = __NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST - 1
5466 };
5467 
5468 /**
5469  * enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes - TX rate set attributes
5470  * @__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID: invalid
5471  * @NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY: Legacy (non-MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection
5472  *	in an array of rates as defined in IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 (u8 values with
5473  *	1 = 500 kbps) but without the IE length restriction (at most
5474  *	%NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES in a single array).
5475  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HT: HT (MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection
5476  *	in an array of MCS numbers.
5477  * @NL80211_TXRATE_VHT: VHT rates allowed for TX rate selection,
5478  *	see &struct nl80211_txrate_vht
5479  * @NL80211_TXRATE_GI: configure GI, see &enum nl80211_txrate_gi
5480  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE: HE rates allowed for TX rate selection,
5481  *	see &struct nl80211_txrate_he
5482  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE_GI: configure HE GI, 0.8us, 1.6us and 3.2us.
5483  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE_LTF: configure HE LTF, 1XLTF, 2XLTF and 4XLTF.
5484  * @__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST: internal
5485  * @NL80211_TXRATE_MAX: highest TX rate attribute
5486  */
5487 enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes {
5488 	__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID,
5489 	NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY,
5490 	NL80211_TXRATE_HT,
5491 	NL80211_TXRATE_VHT,
5492 	NL80211_TXRATE_GI,
5493 	NL80211_TXRATE_HE,
5494 	NL80211_TXRATE_HE_GI,
5495 	NL80211_TXRATE_HE_LTF,
5496 
5497 	/* keep last */
5498 	__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST,
5499 	NL80211_TXRATE_MAX = __NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST - 1
5500 };
5501 
5502 #define NL80211_TXRATE_MCS NL80211_TXRATE_HT
5503 #define NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX		8
5504 
5505 /**
5506  * struct nl80211_txrate_vht - VHT MCS/NSS txrate bitmap
5507  * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.)
5508  */
5509 struct nl80211_txrate_vht {
5510 	__u16 mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
5511 };
5512 
5513 #define NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX		8
5514 /**
5515  * struct nl80211_txrate_he - HE MCS/NSS txrate bitmap
5516  * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.)
5517  */
5518 struct nl80211_txrate_he {
5519 	__u16 mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX];
5520 };
5521 
5522 enum nl80211_txrate_gi {
5523 	NL80211_TXRATE_DEFAULT_GI,
5524 	NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_SGI,
5525 	NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_LGI,
5526 };
5527 
5528 /**
5529  * enum nl80211_band - Frequency band
5530  * @NL80211_BAND_2GHZ: 2.4 GHz ISM band
5531  * @NL80211_BAND_5GHZ: around 5 GHz band (4.9 - 5.7 GHz)
5532  * @NL80211_BAND_60GHZ: around 60 GHz band (58.32 - 69.12 GHz)
5533  * @NL80211_BAND_6GHZ: around 6 GHz band (5.9 - 7.2 GHz)
5534  * @NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ: around 900MHz, supported by S1G PHYs
5535  * @NL80211_BAND_LC: light communication band (placeholder)
5536  * @NUM_NL80211_BANDS: number of bands, avoid using this in userspace
5537  *	since newer kernel versions may support more bands
5538  */
5539 enum nl80211_band {
5540 	NL80211_BAND_2GHZ,
5541 	NL80211_BAND_5GHZ,
5542 	NL80211_BAND_60GHZ,
5543 	NL80211_BAND_6GHZ,
5544 	NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ,
5545 	NL80211_BAND_LC,
5546 
5547 	NUM_NL80211_BANDS,
5548 };
5549 
5550 /**
5551  * enum nl80211_ps_state - powersave state
5552  * @NL80211_PS_DISABLED: powersave is disabled
5553  * @NL80211_PS_ENABLED: powersave is enabled
5554  */
5555 enum nl80211_ps_state {
5556 	NL80211_PS_DISABLED,
5557 	NL80211_PS_ENABLED,
5558 };
5559 
5560 /**
5561  * enum nl80211_attr_cqm - connection quality monitor attributes
5562  * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID: invalid
5563  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This value specifies
5564  *	the threshold for the RSSI level at which an event will be sent. Zero
5565  *	to disable.  Alternatively, if %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST is
5566  *	set, multiple values can be supplied as a low-to-high sorted array of
5567  *	threshold values in dBm.  Events will be sent when the RSSI value
5568  *	crosses any of the thresholds.
5569  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST: RSSI hysteresis in dBm. This value specifies
5570  *	the minimum amount the RSSI level must change after an event before a
5571  *	new event may be issued (to reduce effects of RSSI oscillation).
5572  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT: RSSI threshold event
5573  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT: a u32 value indicating that this many
5574  *	consecutive packets were not acknowledged by the peer
5575  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE: TX error rate in %. Minimum % of TX failures
5576  *	during the given %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before an
5577  *	%NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM with reported %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE and
5578  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS is generated.
5579  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS: number of attempted packets in a given
5580  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE is
5581  *	checked.
5582  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL: interval in seconds. Specifies the periodic
5583  *	interval in which %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS and
5584  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE must be satisfied before generating an
5585  *	%NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM. Set to 0 to turn off TX error reporting.
5586  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: flag attribute that's set in a beacon
5587  *	loss event
5588  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL: the RSSI value in dBm that triggered the
5589  *	RSSI threshold event.
5590  * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST: internal
5591  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX: highest key attribute
5592  */
5593 enum nl80211_attr_cqm {
5594 	__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID,
5595 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD,
5596 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST,
5597 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT,
5598 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT,
5599 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE,
5600 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS,
5601 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL,
5602 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT,
5603 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL,
5604 
5605 	/* keep last */
5606 	__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST,
5607 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST - 1
5608 };
5609 
5610 /**
5611  * enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event - RSSI threshold event
5612  * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW: The RSSI level is lower than the
5613  *      configured threshold
5614  * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH: The RSSI is higher than the
5615  *      configured threshold
5616  * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: (reserved, never sent)
5617  */
5618 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event {
5619 	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW,
5620 	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH,
5621 	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT,
5622 };
5623 
5624 
5625 /**
5626  * enum nl80211_tx_power_setting - TX power adjustment
5627  * @NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine transmit power
5628  * @NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED: limit TX power by the mBm parameter
5629  * @NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED: fix TX power to the mBm parameter
5630  */
5631 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting {
5632 	NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC,
5633 	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED,
5634 	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED,
5635 };
5636 
5637 /**
5638  * enum nl80211_tid_config - TID config state
5639  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE: Enable config for the TID
5640  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE: Disable config for the TID
5641  */
5642 enum nl80211_tid_config {
5643 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE,
5644 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE,
5645 };
5646 
5647 /* enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting - TX rate configuration type
5648  * @NL80211_TX_RATE_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine TX rate
5649  * @NL80211_TX_RATE_LIMITED: limit the TX rate by the TX rate parameter
5650  * @NL80211_TX_RATE_FIXED: fix TX rate to the TX rate parameter
5651  */
5652 enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting {
5653 	NL80211_TX_RATE_AUTOMATIC,
5654 	NL80211_TX_RATE_LIMITED,
5655 	NL80211_TX_RATE_FIXED,
5656 };
5657 
5658 /* enum nl80211_tid_config_attr - TID specific configuration.
5659  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD: pad attribute for 64-bit values
5660  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP: a bitmap (u64) of attributes supported
5661  *	for per-vif configuration; doesn't list the ones that are generic
5662  *	(%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS, %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE).
5663  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP: same as the previous per-vif one, but
5664  *	per peer instead.
5665  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE: flag attribute, if set indicates
5666  *	that the new configuration overrides all previous peer
5667  *	configurations, otherwise previous peer specific configurations
5668  *	should be left untouched.
5669  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS: a bitmask value of TIDs (bit 0 to 7)
5670  *	Its type is u16.
5671  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK: Configure ack policy for the TID.
5672  *	specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TID. see %enum nl80211_tid_config.
5673  *	Its type is u8.
5674  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT: Number of retries used with data frame
5675  *	transmission, user-space sets this configuration in
5676  *	&NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. It is u8 type, min value is 1 and
5677  *	the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on
5678  *	output in wiphy capabilities.
5679  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG: Number of retries used with data frame
5680  *	transmission, user-space sets this configuration in
5681  *	&NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. Its type is u8, min value is 1 and
5682  *	the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on
5683  *	output in wiphy capabilities.
5684  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation
5685  *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS.
5686  *	Its type is u8, using the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5687  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL: Enable/Disable RTS_CTS for the TIDs
5688  *	specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. It is u8 type, using
5689  *	the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5690  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMSDU_CTRL: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation
5691  *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS.
5692  *	Its type is u8, using the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5693  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE_TYPE: This attribute will be useful
5694  *	to notfiy the driver that what type of txrate should be used
5695  *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. using
5696  *	the values form &nl80211_tx_rate_setting.
5697  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE: Data frame TX rate mask should be applied
5698  *	with the parameters passed through %NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES.
5699  *	configuration is applied to the data frame for the tid to that connected
5700  *	station.
5701  */
5702 enum nl80211_tid_config_attr {
5703 	__NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID,
5704 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD,
5705 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP,
5706 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP,
5707 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE,
5708 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS,
5709 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK,
5710 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT,
5711 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG,
5712 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL,
5713 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL,
5714 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMSDU_CTRL,
5715 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE_TYPE,
5716 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE,
5717 
5718 	/* keep last */
5719 	__NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
5720 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
5721 };
5722 
5723 /**
5724  * enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr - packet pattern attribute
5725  * @__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
5726  * @NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN: the pattern, values where the mask has
5727  *	a zero bit are ignored
5728  * @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK: pattern mask, must be long enough to have
5729  *	a bit for each byte in the pattern. The lowest-order bit corresponds
5730  *	to the first byte of the pattern, but the bytes of the pattern are
5731  *	in a little-endian-like format, i.e. the 9th byte of the pattern
5732  *	corresponds to the lowest-order bit in the second byte of the mask.
5733  *	For example: The match 00:xx:00:00:xx:00:00:00:00:xx:xx:xx (where
5734  *	xx indicates "don't care") would be represented by a pattern of
5735  *	twelve zero bytes, and a mask of "0xed,0x01".
5736  *	Note that the pattern matching is done as though frames were not
5737  *	802.11 frames but 802.3 frames, i.e. the frame is fully unpacked
5738  *	first (including SNAP header unpacking) and then matched.
5739  * @NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET: packet offset, pattern is matched after
5740  *	these fixed number of bytes of received packet
5741  * @NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT: number of attributes
5742  * @MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT: max attribute number
5743  */
5744 enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr {
5745 	__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID,
5746 	NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK,
5747 	NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN,
5748 	NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET,
5749 
5750 	NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT,
5751 	MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT = NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT - 1,
5752 };
5753 
5754 /**
5755  * struct nl80211_pattern_support - packet pattern support information
5756  * @max_patterns: maximum number of patterns supported
5757  * @min_pattern_len: minimum length of each pattern
5758  * @max_pattern_len: maximum length of each pattern
5759  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5760  *
5761  * This struct is carried in %NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN when
5762  * that is part of %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED or in
5763  * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN when that is part of
5764  * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the capability information given
5765  * by the kernel to userspace.
5766  */
5767 struct nl80211_pattern_support {
5768 	__u32 max_patterns;
5769 	__u32 min_pattern_len;
5770 	__u32 max_pattern_len;
5771 	__u32 max_pkt_offset;
5772 } __attribute__((packed));
5773 
5774 /* only for backward compatibility */
5775 #define __NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_INVALID __NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID
5776 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_MASK NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK
5777 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_PATTERN NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN
5778 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_OFFSET NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET
5779 #define NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT
5780 #define MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT
5781 #define nl80211_wowlan_pattern_support nl80211_pattern_support
5782 
5783 /**
5784  * enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers - WoWLAN trigger definitions
5785  * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5786  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY: wake up on any activity, do not really put
5787  *	the chip into a special state -- works best with chips that have
5788  *	support for low-power operation already (flag)
5789  *	Note that this mode is incompatible with all of the others, if
5790  *	any others are even supported by the device.
5791  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT: wake up on disconnect, the way disconnect
5792  *	is detected is implementation-specific (flag)
5793  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT: wake up on magic packet (6x 0xff, followed
5794  *	by 16 repetitions of MAC addr, anywhere in payload) (flag)
5795  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN: wake up on the specified packet patterns
5796  *	which are passed in an array of nested attributes, each nested attribute
5797  *	defining a with attributes from &struct nl80211_wowlan_trig_pkt_pattern.
5798  *	Each pattern defines a wakeup packet. Packet offset is associated with
5799  *	each pattern which is used while matching the pattern. The matching is
5800  *	done on the MSDU, i.e. as though the packet was an 802.3 packet, so the
5801  *	pattern matching is done after the packet is converted to the MSDU.
5802  *
5803  *	In %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED, it is a binary attribute
5804  *	carrying a &struct nl80211_pattern_support.
5805  *
5806  *	When reporting wakeup. it is a u32 attribute containing the 0-based
5807  *	index of the pattern that caused the wakeup, in the patterns passed
5808  *	to the kernel when configuring.
5809  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED: Not a real trigger, and cannot be
5810  *	used when setting, used only to indicate that GTK rekeying is supported
5811  *	by the device (flag)
5812  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: wake up on GTK rekey failure (if
5813  *	done by the device) (flag)
5814  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST: wake up on EAP Identity Request
5815  *	packet (flag)
5816  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: wake up on 4-way handshake (flag)
5817  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE: wake up when rfkill is released
5818  *	(on devices that have rfkill in the device) (flag)
5819  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211: For wakeup reporting only, contains
5820  *	the 802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a deauth frame. The frame
5821  *	may be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN
5822  *	attribute contains the original length.
5823  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN: Original length of the 802.11
5824  *	packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211
5825  *	attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere.
5826  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023: For wakeup reporting only, contains the
5827  *	802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a magic packet. The frame may
5828  *	be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN attribute
5829  *	contains the original length.
5830  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN: Original length of the 802.3
5831  *	packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023
5832  *	attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere.
5833  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION: TCP connection wake, see DOC section
5834  *	"TCP connection wakeup" for more details. This is a nested attribute
5835  *	containing the exact information for establishing and keeping alive
5836  *	the TCP connection.
5837  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_MATCH: For wakeup reporting only, the
5838  *	wakeup packet was received on the TCP connection
5839  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST: For wakeup reporting only, the
5840  *	TCP connection was lost or failed to be established
5841  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS: For wakeup reporting only,
5842  *	the TCP connection ran out of tokens to use for data to send to the
5843  *	service
5844  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT: wake up when a configured network
5845  *	is detected.  This is a nested attribute that contains the
5846  *	same attributes used with @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN.  It
5847  *	specifies how the scan is performed (e.g. the interval, the
5848  *	channels to scan and the initial delay) as well as the scan
5849  *	results that will trigger a wake (i.e. the matchsets).  This
5850  *	attribute is also sent in a response to
5851  *	@NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY, indicating the number of match sets
5852  *	supported by the driver (u32).
5853  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS: nested attribute
5854  *	containing an array with information about what triggered the
5855  *	wake up.  If no elements are present in the array, it means
5856  *	that the information is not available.  If more than one
5857  *	element is present, it means that more than one match
5858  *	occurred.
5859  *	Each element in the array is a nested attribute that contains
5860  *	one optional %NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute and one optional
5861  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES attribute.  At least one of
5862  *	these attributes must be present.  If
5863  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES contains more than one
5864  *	frequency, it means that the match occurred in more than one
5865  *	channel.
5866  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_UNPROTECTED_DEAUTH_DISASSOC: For wakeup reporting only.
5867  *	Wake up happened due to unprotected deauth or disassoc frame in MFP.
5868  * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: number of wake on wireless triggers
5869  * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: highest wowlan trigger attribute number
5870  *
5871  * These nested attributes are used to configure the wakeup triggers and
5872  * to report the wakeup reason(s).
5873  */
5874 enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers {
5875 	__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID,
5876 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY,
5877 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT,
5878 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT,
5879 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN,
5880 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED,
5881 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE,
5882 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST,
5883 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE,
5884 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE,
5885 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211,
5886 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN,
5887 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023,
5888 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN,
5889 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION,
5890 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_MATCH,
5891 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST,
5892 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS,
5893 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT,
5894 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS,
5895 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_UNPROTECTED_DEAUTH_DISASSOC,
5896 
5897 	/* keep last */
5898 	NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG,
5899 	MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG - 1
5900 };
5901 
5902 /**
5903  * DOC: TCP connection wakeup
5904  *
5905  * Some devices can establish a TCP connection in order to be woken up by a
5906  * packet coming in from outside their network segment, or behind NAT. If
5907  * configured, the device will establish a TCP connection to the given
5908  * service, and periodically send data to that service. The first data
5909  * packet is usually transmitted after SYN/ACK, also ACKing the SYN/ACK.
5910  * The data packets can optionally include a (little endian) sequence
5911  * number (in the TCP payload!) that is generated by the device, and, also
5912  * optionally, a token from a list of tokens. This serves as a keep-alive
5913  * with the service, and for NATed connections, etc.
5914  *
5915  * During this keep-alive period, the server doesn't send any data to the
5916  * client. When receiving data, it is compared against the wakeup pattern
5917  * (and mask) and if it matches, the host is woken up. Similarly, if the
5918  * connection breaks or cannot be established to start with, the host is
5919  * also woken up.
5920  *
5921  * Developer's note: ARP offload is required for this, otherwise TCP
5922  * response packets might not go through correctly.
5923  */
5924 
5925 /**
5926  * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq - WoWLAN TCP data sequence
5927  * @start: starting value
5928  * @offset: offset of sequence number in packet
5929  * @len: length of the sequence value to write, 1 through 4
5930  *
5931  * Note: don't confuse with the TCP sequence number(s), this is for the
5932  * keepalive packet payload. The actual value is written into the packet
5933  * in little endian.
5934  */
5935 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq {
5936 	__u32 start, offset, len;
5937 };
5938 
5939 /**
5940  * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token - WoWLAN TCP data token config
5941  * @offset: offset of token in packet
5942  * @len: length of each token
5943  * @token_stream: stream of data to be used for the tokens, the length must
5944  *	be a multiple of @len for this to make sense
5945  */
5946 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token {
5947 	__u32 offset, len;
5948 	__u8 token_stream[];
5949 };
5950 
5951 /**
5952  * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature - data token features
5953  * @min_len: minimum token length
5954  * @max_len: maximum token length
5955  * @bufsize: total available token buffer size (max size of @token_stream)
5956  */
5957 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature {
5958 	__u32 min_len, max_len, bufsize;
5959 };
5960 
5961 /**
5962  * enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs - WoWLAN TCP connection parameters
5963  * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5964  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4: source IPv4 address (in network byte order)
5965  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4: destination IPv4 address
5966  *	(in network byte order)
5967  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC: destination MAC address, this is given because
5968  *	route lookup when configured might be invalid by the time we suspend,
5969  *	and doing a route lookup when suspending is no longer possible as it
5970  *	might require ARP querying.
5971  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT: source port (u16); optional, if not given a
5972  *	socket and port will be allocated
5973  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT: destination port (u16)
5974  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD: data packet payload, at least one byte.
5975  *	For feature advertising, a u32 attribute holding the maximum length
5976  *	of the data payload.
5977  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ: data packet sequence configuration
5978  *	(if desired), a &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq. For feature
5979  *	advertising it is just a flag
5980  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN: data packet token configuration,
5981  *	see &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token and for advertising see
5982  *	&struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature.
5983  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL: data interval in seconds, maximum
5984  *	interval in feature advertising (u32)
5985  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD: wake packet payload, for advertising a
5986  *	u32 attribute holding the maximum length
5987  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK: Wake packet payload mask, not used for
5988  *	feature advertising. The mask works like @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK
5989  *	but on the TCP payload only.
5990  * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: number of TCP attributes
5991  * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: highest attribute number
5992  */
5993 enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs {
5994 	__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID,
5995 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4,
5996 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4,
5997 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC,
5998 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT,
5999 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT,
6000 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD,
6001 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ,
6002 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN,
6003 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL,
6004 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD,
6005 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK,
6006 
6007 	/* keep last */
6008 	NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP,
6009 	MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP - 1
6010 };
6011 
6012 /**
6013  * struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support - coalesce rule support information
6014  * @max_rules: maximum number of rules supported
6015  * @pat: packet pattern support information
6016  * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
6017  *
6018  * This struct is carried in %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the
6019  * capability information given by the kernel to userspace.
6020  */
6021 struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support {
6022 	__u32 max_rules;
6023 	struct nl80211_pattern_support pat;
6024 	__u32 max_delay;
6025 } __attribute__((packed));
6026 
6027 /**
6028  * enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule - coalesce rule attribute
6029  * @__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
6030  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY: delay in msecs used for packet coalescing
6031  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION: condition for packet coalescence,
6032  *	see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
6033  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN: packet offset, pattern is matched
6034  *	after these fixed number of bytes of received packet
6035  * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: number of attributes
6036  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX: max attribute number
6037  */
6038 enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule {
6039 	__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID,
6040 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY,
6041 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION,
6042 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN,
6043 
6044 	/* keep last */
6045 	NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE,
6046 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE - 1
6047 };
6048 
6049 /**
6050  * enum nl80211_coalesce_condition - coalesce rule conditions
6051  * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH: coalesce Rx packets when patterns
6052  *	in a rule are matched.
6053  * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH: coalesce Rx packets when patterns
6054  *	in a rule are not matched.
6055  */
6056 enum nl80211_coalesce_condition {
6057 	NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH,
6058 	NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH
6059 };
6060 
6061 /**
6062  * enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs - limit attributes
6063  * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC: (reserved)
6064  * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX: maximum number of interfaces that
6065  *	can be chosen from this set of interface types (u32)
6066  * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES: nested attribute containing a
6067  *	flag attribute for each interface type in this set
6068  * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: number of attributes
6069  * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: highest attribute number
6070  */
6071 enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs {
6072 	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC,
6073 	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX,
6074 	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES,
6075 
6076 	/* keep last */
6077 	NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT,
6078 	MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT - 1
6079 };
6080 
6081 /**
6082  * enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs -- interface combination attributes
6083  *
6084  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC: (reserved)
6085  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS: Nested attributes containing the limits
6086  *	for given interface types, see &enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs.
6087  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM: u32 attribute giving the total number of
6088  *	interfaces that can be created in this group. This number doesn't
6089  *	apply to interfaces purely managed in software, which are listed
6090  *	in a separate attribute %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACES_SOFTWARE.
6091  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH: flag attribute specifying that
6092  *	beacon intervals within this group must be all the same even for
6093  *	infrastructure and AP/GO combinations, i.e. the GO(s) must adopt
6094  *	the infrastructure network's beacon interval.
6095  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS: u32 attribute specifying how many
6096  *	different channels may be used within this group.
6097  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap
6098  *	of supported channel widths for radar detection.
6099  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap
6100  *	of supported regulatory regions for radar detection.
6101  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD: u32 attribute specifying the minimum GCD of
6102  *	different beacon intervals supported by all the interface combinations
6103  *	in this group (if not present, all beacon intervals be identical).
6104  * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: number of attributes
6105  * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: highest attribute number
6106  *
6107  * Examples:
6108  *	limits = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{AP} <= 1 ], matching BI, channels = 1, max = 2
6109  *	=> allows an AP and a STA that must match BIs
6110  *
6111  *	numbers = [ #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8 ], BI min gcd, channels = 1, max = 8,
6112  *	=> allows 8 of AP/GO that can have BI gcd >= min gcd
6113  *
6114  *	numbers = [ #{STA} <= 2 ], channels = 2, max = 2
6115  *	=> allows two STAs on the same or on different channels
6116  *
6117  *	numbers = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 ], max = 4
6118  *	=> allows a STA plus three P2P interfaces
6119  *
6120  * The list of these four possibilities could completely be contained
6121  * within the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute to indicate
6122  * that any of these groups must match.
6123  *
6124  * "Combinations" of just a single interface will not be listed here,
6125  * a single interface of any valid interface type is assumed to always
6126  * be possible by itself. This means that implicitly, for each valid
6127  * interface type, the following group always exists:
6128  *	numbers = [ #{<type>} <= 1 ], channels = 1, max = 1
6129  */
6130 enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs {
6131 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC,
6132 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS,
6133 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM,
6134 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH,
6135 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS,
6136 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS,
6137 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS,
6138 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD,
6139 
6140 	/* keep last */
6141 	NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB,
6142 	MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB - 1
6143 };
6144 
6145 
6146 /**
6147  * enum nl80211_plink_state - state of a mesh peer link finite state machine
6148  *
6149  * @NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN: initial state, considered the implicit
6150  *	state of non-existent mesh peer links
6151  * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT: mesh plink open frame has been sent to
6152  *	this mesh peer
6153  * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD: mesh plink open frame has been received
6154  *	from this mesh peer
6155  * @NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD: mesh plink confirm frame has been
6156  *	received from this mesh peer
6157  * @NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB: mesh peer link is established
6158  * @NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING: mesh peer link is being closed or cancelled
6159  * @NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED: all frames transmitted from this mesh
6160  *	plink are discarded, except for authentication frames
6161  * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: number of peer link states
6162  * @MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: highest numerical value of plink states
6163  */
6164 enum nl80211_plink_state {
6165 	NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN,
6166 	NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT,
6167 	NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD,
6168 	NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD,
6169 	NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB,
6170 	NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING,
6171 	NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED,
6172 
6173 	/* keep last */
6174 	NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES,
6175 	MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES = NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES - 1
6176 };
6177 
6178 /**
6179  * enum nl80211_plink_action - actions to perform in mesh peers
6180  *
6181  * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION: perform no action
6182  * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN: start mesh peer link establishment
6183  * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK: block traffic from this mesh peer
6184  * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS: number of possible actions
6185  */
6186 enum nl80211_plink_action {
6187 	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION,
6188 	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN,
6189 	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK,
6190 
6191 	NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS,
6192 };
6193 
6194 
6195 #define NL80211_KCK_LEN			16
6196 #define NL80211_KEK_LEN			16
6197 #define NL80211_KCK_EXT_LEN		24
6198 #define NL80211_KEK_EXT_LEN		32
6199 #define NL80211_KCK_EXT_LEN_32		32
6200 #define NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN		8
6201 
6202 /**
6203  * enum nl80211_rekey_data - attributes for GTK rekey offload
6204  * @__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
6205  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK: key encryption key (binary)
6206  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK: key confirmation key (binary)
6207  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR: replay counter (binary)
6208  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_AKM: AKM data (OUI, suite type)
6209  * @NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: number of rekey attributes (internal)
6210  * @MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: highest rekey attribute (internal)
6211  */
6212 enum nl80211_rekey_data {
6213 	__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID,
6214 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK,
6215 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK,
6216 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR,
6217 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_AKM,
6218 
6219 	/* keep last */
6220 	NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA,
6221 	MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA = NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA - 1
6222 };
6223 
6224 /**
6225  * enum nl80211_hidden_ssid - values for %NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID
6226  * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE: do not hide SSID (i.e., broadcast it in
6227  *	Beacon frames)
6228  * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN: hide SSID by using zero-length SSID element
6229  *	in Beacon frames
6230  * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS: hide SSID by using correct length of SSID
6231  *	element in Beacon frames but zero out each byte in the SSID
6232  */
6233 enum nl80211_hidden_ssid {
6234 	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE,
6235 	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN,
6236 	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS
6237 };
6238 
6239 /**
6240  * enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr - station WME attributes
6241  * @__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
6242  * @NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES: bitmap of uapsd queues. the format
6243  *	is the same as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field.
6244  * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP: max service period. the format is the same
6245  *	as the MAX_SP field in the QoS info field (but already shifted down).
6246  * @__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST: internal
6247  * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX: highest station WME attribute
6248  */
6249 enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr {
6250 	__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID,
6251 	NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES,
6252 	NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP,
6253 
6254 	/* keep last */
6255 	__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST,
6256 	NL80211_STA_WME_MAX = __NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST - 1
6257 };
6258 
6259 /**
6260  * enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr - attributes for PMKSA caching candidates
6261  * @__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
6262  * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX: candidate index (u32; the smaller, the higher
6263  *	priority)
6264  * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID: candidate BSSID (6 octets)
6265  * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH: RSN pre-authentication supported (flag)
6266  * @NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: number of PMKSA caching candidate attributes
6267  *	(internal)
6268  * @MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: highest PMKSA caching candidate attribute
6269  *	(internal)
6270  */
6271 enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr {
6272 	__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID,
6273 	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX,
6274 	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID,
6275 	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH,
6276 
6277 	/* keep last */
6278 	NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
6279 	MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE = NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE - 1
6280 };
6281 
6282 /**
6283  * enum nl80211_tdls_operation - values for %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION
6284  * @NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ: Send a TDLS discovery request
6285  * @NL80211_TDLS_SETUP: Setup TDLS link
6286  * @NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN: Teardown a TDLS link which is already established
6287  * @NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK: Enable TDLS link
6288  * @NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK: Disable TDLS link
6289  */
6290 enum nl80211_tdls_operation {
6291 	NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ,
6292 	NL80211_TDLS_SETUP,
6293 	NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN,
6294 	NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK,
6295 	NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK,
6296 };
6297 
6298 /**
6299  * enum nl80211_ap_sme_features - device-integrated AP features
6300  * @NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD: SA Query procedures offloaded to driver
6301  *	when user space indicates support for SA Query procedures offload during
6302  *	"start ap" with %NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT.
6303  */
6304 enum nl80211_ap_sme_features {
6305 	NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD		= 1 << 0,
6306 };
6307 
6308 /**
6309  * enum nl80211_feature_flags - device/driver features
6310  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS: This driver supports reflecting back
6311  *	TX status to the socket error queue when requested with the
6312  *	socket option.
6313  * @NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with HT datarates.
6314  * @NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER: This driver takes care of freeing up
6315  *	the connected inactive stations in AP mode.
6316  * @NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS: This driver has been tested
6317  *	to work properly to support receiving regulatory hints from
6318  *	cellular base stations.
6319  * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL: (no longer available, only
6320  *	here to reserve the value for API/ABI compatibility)
6321  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SAE: This driver supports simultaneous authentication of
6322  *	equals (SAE) with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station
6323  *	mode
6324  * @NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN: This driver supports low priority scan
6325  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH: Scan flush is supported
6326  * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN: Support scanning using an AP vif
6327  * @NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER: The driver supports per-vif TX power setting
6328  * @NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN: The driver expects userspace to perform
6329  *	OBSS scans and generate 20/40 BSS coex reports. This flag is used only
6330  *	for drivers implementing the CONNECT API, for AUTH/ASSOC it is implied.
6331  * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN: P2P GO implementation supports CT Window
6332  *	setting
6333  * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS: P2P GO implementation supports opportunistic
6334  *	powersave
6335  * @NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE: The driver supports full state
6336  *	transitions for AP clients. Without this flag (and if the driver
6337  *	doesn't have the AP SME in the device) the driver supports adding
6338  *	stations only when they're associated and adds them in associated
6339  *	state (to later be transitioned into authorized), with this flag
6340  *	they should be added before even sending the authentication reply
6341  *	and then transitioned into authenticated, associated and authorized
6342  *	states using station flags.
6343  *	Note that even for drivers that support this, the default is to add
6344  *	stations in authenticated/associated state, so to add unauthenticated
6345  *	stations the authenticated/associated bits have to be set in the mask.
6346  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS: cfg80211 advertises channel limits
6347  *	(HT40, VHT 80/160 MHz) if this flag is set
6348  * @NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM: This driver supports a userspace Mesh
6349  *	Peering Management entity which may be implemented by registering for
6350  *	beacons or NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE events. The mesh beacon is
6351  *	still generated by the driver.
6352  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR: This driver supports an active monitor
6353  *	interface. An active monitor interface behaves like a normal monitor
6354  *	interface, but gets added to the driver. It ensures that incoming
6355  *	unicast packets directed at the configured interface address get ACKed.
6356  * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE: This driver supports dynamic
6357  *	channel bandwidth change (e.g., HT 20 <-> 40 MHz channel) during the
6358  *	lifetime of a BSS.
6359  * @NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a DS Parameter
6360  *	Set IE to probe requests.
6361  * @NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a WFA TPC Report IE
6362  *	to probe requests.
6363  * @NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET: This device, in client mode, supports Quiet Period
6364  *	requests sent to it by an AP.
6365  * @NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION: This device is capable of inserting the
6366  *	current tx power value into the TPC Report IE in the spectrum
6367  *	management TPC Report action frame, and in the Radio Measurement Link
6368  *	Measurement Report action frame.
6369  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION: This driver supports dynamic ACK timeout
6370  *	estimation (dynack). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK flag attribute is used
6371  *	to enable dynack.
6372  * @NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS: Device supports static spatial
6373  *	multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain
6374  *	even on HT connections that should be using more chains.
6375  * @NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS: Device supports dynamic spatial
6376  *	multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain
6377  *	and then wake the rest up as required after, for example,
6378  *	rts/cts handshake.
6379  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION: the device supports setting up WMM
6380  *	TSPEC sessions (TID aka TSID 0-7) with the %NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS
6381  *	command. Standard IEEE 802.11 TSPEC setup is not yet supported, it
6382  *	needs to be able to handle Block-Ack agreements and other things.
6383  * @NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE: Device supports configuring
6384  *	the vif's MAC address upon creation.
6385  *	See 'macaddr' field in the vif_params (cfg80211.h).
6386  * @NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Driver supports channel switching when
6387  *	operating as a TDLS peer.
6388  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a
6389  *	random MAC address during scan (if the device is unassociated); the
6390  *	%NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR flag may be set for scans and the MAC
6391  *	address mask/value will be used.
6392  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports
6393  *	using a random MAC address for every scan iteration during scheduled
6394  *	scan (while not associated), the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may
6395  *	be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used.
6396  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a
6397  *	random MAC address for every scan iteration during "net detect", i.e.
6398  *	scan in unassociated WoWLAN, the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may
6399  *	be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used.
6400  */
6401 enum nl80211_feature_flags {
6402 	NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS			= 1 << 0,
6403 	NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS				= 1 << 1,
6404 	NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER		= 1 << 2,
6405 	NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS		= 1 << 3,
6406 	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL	= 1 << 4,
6407 	NL80211_FEATURE_SAE				= 1 << 5,
6408 	NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN		= 1 << 6,
6409 	NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH			= 1 << 7,
6410 	NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN				= 1 << 8,
6411 	NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER			= 1 << 9,
6412 	NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN			= 1 << 10,
6413 	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN			= 1 << 11,
6414 	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS			= 1 << 12,
6415 	/* bit 13 is reserved */
6416 	NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS		= 1 << 14,
6417 	NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE		= 1 << 15,
6418 	NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM			= 1 << 16,
6419 	NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR			= 1 << 17,
6420 	NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE	= 1 << 18,
6421 	NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES	= 1 << 19,
6422 	NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES		= 1 << 20,
6423 	NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET				= 1 << 21,
6424 	NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION		= 1 << 22,
6425 	NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION		= 1 << 23,
6426 	NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS			= 1 << 24,
6427 	NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS			= 1 << 25,
6428 	NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION		= 1 << 26,
6429 	NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE			= 1 << 27,
6430 	NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH		= 1 << 28,
6431 	NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR		= 1 << 29,
6432 	NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR	= 1 << 30,
6433 	NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR		= 1U << 31,
6434 };
6435 
6436 /**
6437  * enum nl80211_ext_feature_index - bit index of extended features.
6438  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with VHT datarates.
6439  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM: This driver supports RRM. When featured, user can
6440  *	request to use RRM (see %NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM) with
6441  *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests, which will set
6442  *	the ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM flag in the association request even if
6443  *	NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET is not advertised.
6444  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER: This device supports MU-MIMO air
6445  *	sniffer which means that it can be configured to hear packets from
6446  *	certain groups which can be configured by the
6447  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA attribute,
6448  *	or can be configured to follow a station by configuring the
6449  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR attribute.
6450  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME: This driver includes the actual
6451  *	time the scan started in scan results event. The time is the TSF of
6452  *	the BSS that the interface that requested the scan is connected to
6453  *	(if available).
6454  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF: Per BSS, this driver reports the
6455  *	time the last beacon/probe was received. For a non-MLO connection, the
6456  *	time is the TSF of the BSS that the interface that requested the scan is
6457  *	connected to (if available). For an MLO connection, the time is the TSF
6458  *	of the BSS corresponding with link ID specified in the scan request (if
6459  *	specified).
6460  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL: This driver supports configuration of
6461  *	channel dwell time.
6462  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY: Driver supports beacon rate
6463  *	configuration (AP/mesh), supporting a legacy (non-HT/VHT) rate.
6464  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT: Driver supports beacon rate
6465  *	configuration (AP/mesh) with HT rates.
6466  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT: Driver supports beacon rate
6467  *	configuration (AP/mesh) with VHT rates.
6468  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA: This driver supports Fast Initial Link Setup
6469  *	with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station mode.
6470  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA: This driver supports randomized TA
6471  *	in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while not associated.
6472  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED: This driver supports
6473  *	randomized TA in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while associated.
6474  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: The driver supports sched_scan
6475  *	for reporting BSSs with better RSSI than the current connected BSS
6476  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI).
6477  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST: With this driver the
6478  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD attribute accepts a list of zero or more
6479  *	RSSI threshold values to monitor rather than exactly one threshold.
6480  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD: Driver SME supports FILS shared key
6481  *	authentication with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
6482  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way
6483  *	handshake with PSK in station mode (PSK is passed as part of the connect
6484  *	and associate commands), doing it in the host might not be supported.
6485  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X: Device wants to do doing 4-way
6486  *	handshake with 802.1X in station mode (will pass EAP frames to the host
6487  *	and accept the set_pmk/del_pmk commands), doing it in the host might not
6488  *	be supported.
6489  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: Driver is capable of overriding
6490  *	the max channel attribute in the FILS request params IE with the
6491  *	actual dwell time.
6492  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver accepts broadcast probe
6493  *	response
6494  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: Driver supports sending
6495  *	the first probe request in each channel at rate of at least 5.5Mbps.
6496  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: Driver supports
6497  *	probe request tx deferral and suppression
6498  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL: Driver supports the %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL
6499  *	value in %NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP.
6500  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN: Driver supports low span scan.
6501  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN: Driver supports low power scan.
6502  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN: Driver supports high accuracy scan.
6503  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD: HW/driver will offload DFS actions.
6504  *	Device or driver will do all DFS-related actions by itself,
6505  *	informing user-space about CAC progress, radar detection event,
6506  *	channel change triggered by radar detection event.
6507  *	No need to start CAC from user-space, no need to react to
6508  *	"radar detected" event.
6509  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: Driver supports sending and
6510  *	receiving control port frames over nl80211 instead of the netdevice.
6511  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT: This driver/device supports
6512  *	(average) ACK signal strength reporting.
6513  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT: Backward-compatible ID
6514  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS: Driver supports FQ-CoDel-enabled intermediate
6515  *      TXQs.
6516  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN: Driver/device supports randomizing the
6517  *	SN in probe request frames if requested by %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN.
6518  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: Driver/device can omit all data
6519  *	except for supported rates from the probe request content if requested
6520  *	by the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT flag.
6521  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER: Driver supports enabling fine
6522  *	timing measurement responder role.
6523  *
6524  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0: Driver/device confirm that they are
6525  *      able to rekey an in-use key correctly. Userspace must not rekey PTK keys
6526  *      if this flag is not set. Ignoring this can leak clear text packets and/or
6527  *      freeze the connection.
6528  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID: Driver supports "Extended Key ID for
6529  *      Individually Addressed Frames" from IEEE802.11-2016.
6530  *
6531  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS: Driver supports getting airtime
6532  *	fairness for transmitted packets and has enabled airtime fairness
6533  *	scheduling.
6534  *
6535  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING: Driver/device supports PMKSA caching
6536  *	(set/del PMKSA operations) in AP mode.
6537  *
6538  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD: Obsolete
6539  *
6540  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR: This driver supports controlling tx power
6541  *	to a station.
6542  *
6543  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD: Device wants to do SAE authentication in
6544  *	station mode (SAE password is passed as part of the connect command).
6545  *
6546  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD: The driver supports a single netdev
6547  *	with VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs added using
6548  *	vconfig similarly to the Ethernet case.
6549  *
6550  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL: The driver supports the Airtime Queue Limit (AQL)
6551  *	feature, which prevents bufferbloat by using the expected transmission
6552  *	time to limit the amount of data buffered in the hardware.
6553  *
6554  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION: The driver supports Beacon protection
6555  *	and can receive key configuration for BIGTK using key indexes 6 and 7.
6556  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION_CLIENT: The driver supports Beacon
6557  *	protection as a client only and cannot transmit protected beacons.
6558  *
6559  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH: The driver can disable the
6560  *	forwarding of preauth frames over the control port. They are then
6561  *	handled as ordinary data frames.
6562  *
6563  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROTECTED_TWT: Driver supports protected TWT frames
6564  *
6565  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DEL_IBSS_STA: The driver supports removing stations
6566  *      in IBSS mode, essentially by dropping their state.
6567  *
6568  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS: management frame registrations
6569  *	are possible for multicast frames and those will be reported properly.
6570  *
6571  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ: This driver supports receiving and
6572  *	reporting scan request with %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ. In order to
6573  *	report %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ, %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ must be
6574  *	included in the scan request.
6575  *
6576  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211_TX_STATUS: The driver
6577  *	can report tx status for control port over nl80211 tx operations.
6578  *
6579  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OPERATING_CHANNEL_VALIDATION: Driver supports Operating
6580  *	Channel Validation (OCV) when using driver's SME for RSNA handshakes.
6581  *
6582  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way
6583  *	handshake with PSK in AP mode (PSK is passed as part of the start AP
6584  *	command).
6585  *
6586  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP: Device wants to do SAE authentication
6587  *	in AP mode (SAE password is passed as part of the start AP command).
6588  *
6589  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_DISCOVERY: Driver/device supports FILS discovery
6590  *	frames transmission
6591  *
6592  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver/device supports
6593  *	unsolicited broadcast probe response transmission
6594  *
6595  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE: Driver supports beacon rate
6596  *	configuration (AP/mesh) with HE rates.
6597  *
6598  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_LTF: Device supports secure LTF measurement
6599  *      exchange protocol.
6600  *
6601  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_RTT: Device supports secure RTT measurement
6602  *      exchange protocol.
6603  *
6604  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROT_RANGE_NEGO_AND_MEASURE: Device supports management
6605  *      frame protection for all management frames exchanged during the
6606  *      negotiation and range measurement procedure.
6607  *
6608  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_COLOR: The driver supports BSS color collision
6609  *	detection and change announcemnts.
6610  *
6611  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD: Driver running in AP mode supports
6612  *	FILS encryption and decryption for (Re)Association Request and Response
6613  *	frames. Userspace has to share FILS AAD details to the driver by using
6614  *	@NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD.
6615  *
6616  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RADAR_BACKGROUND: Device supports background radar/CAC
6617  *	detection.
6618  *
6619  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_POWERED_ADDR_CHANGE: Device can perform a MAC address
6620  *	change without having to bring the underlying network device down
6621  *	first. For example, in station mode this can be used to vary the
6622  *	origin MAC address prior to a connection to a new AP for privacy
6623  *	or other reasons. Note that certain driver specific restrictions
6624  *	might apply, e.g. no scans in progress, no offchannel operations
6625  *	in progress, and no active connections.
6626  *
6627  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PUNCT: Driver supports preamble puncturing in AP mode.
6628  *
6629  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_NAN: Device supports NAN Pairing which enables
6630  *	authentication, data encryption and message integrity.
6631  *
6632  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AUTH_AND_DEAUTH_RANDOM_TA: Device supports randomized TA
6633  *	in authentication and deauthentication frames sent to unassociated peer
6634  *	using @NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
6635  *
6636  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD: Driver/Device wants to do OWE DH IE
6637  *	handling in station mode.
6638  *
6639  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD_AP: Driver/Device wants to do OWE DH IE
6640  *	handling in AP mode.
6641  *
6642  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_CONCURRENT: The device supports peer-to-peer or
6643  *	ad hoc operation on DFS channels under the control of a concurrent
6644  *	DFS master on the same channel as described in FCC-594280 D01
6645  *	(Section B.3). This, for example, allows P2P GO and P2P clients to
6646  *	operate on DFS channels as long as there's a concurrent BSS connection.
6647  *
6648  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SPP_AMSDU_SUPPORT: The driver has support for SPP
6649  *	(signaling and payload protected) A-MSDUs and this shall be advertised
6650  *	in the RSNXE.
6651  *
6652  * @NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: number of extended features.
6653  * @MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: highest extended feature index.
6654  */
6655 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index {
6656 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS,
6657 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM,
6658 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER,
6659 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME,
6660 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF,
6661 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL,
6662 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY,
6663 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT,
6664 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT,
6665 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA,
6666 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA,
6667 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED,
6668 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI,
6669 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST,
6670 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD,
6671 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK,
6672 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X,
6673 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME,
6674 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
6675 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE,
6676 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION,
6677 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL,
6678 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN,
6679 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN,
6680 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN,
6681 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD,
6682 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211,
6683 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT,
6684 	/* we renamed this - stay compatible */
6685 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT = NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT,
6686 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS,
6687 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN,
6688 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT,
6689 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0,
6690 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER,
6691 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS,
6692 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING,
6693 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD, /* obsolete */
6694 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID,
6695 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR,
6696 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD,
6697 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD,
6698 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL,
6699 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION,
6700 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH,
6701 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROTECTED_TWT,
6702 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DEL_IBSS_STA,
6703 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS,
6704 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION_CLIENT,
6705 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ,
6706 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211_TX_STATUS,
6707 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OPERATING_CHANNEL_VALIDATION,
6708 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK,
6709 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP,
6710 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_DISCOVERY,
6711 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
6712 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE,
6713 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_LTF,
6714 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_RTT,
6715 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROT_RANGE_NEGO_AND_MEASURE,
6716 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_COLOR,
6717 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD,
6718 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RADAR_BACKGROUND,
6719 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_POWERED_ADDR_CHANGE,
6720 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PUNCT,
6721 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_NAN,
6722 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AUTH_AND_DEAUTH_RANDOM_TA,
6723 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD,
6724 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD_AP,
6725 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_CONCURRENT,
6726 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SPP_AMSDU_SUPPORT,
6727 
6728 	/* add new features before the definition below */
6729 	NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES,
6730 	MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES = NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES - 1
6731 };
6732 
6733 /**
6734  * enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr - optional supported
6735  *	protocols for probe-response offloading by the driver/FW.
6736  *	To be used with the %NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD attribute.
6737  *	Each enum value represents a bit in the bitmap of supported
6738  *	protocols. Typically a subset of probe-requests belonging to a
6739  *	supported protocol will be excluded from offload and uploaded
6740  *	to the host.
6741  *
6742  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS: Support for WPS ver. 1
6743  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2: Support for WPS ver. 2
6744  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P: Support for P2P
6745  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U: Support for 802.11u
6746  */
6747 enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr {
6748 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS =	1<<0,
6749 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2 =	1<<1,
6750 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P =	1<<2,
6751 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U =	1<<3,
6752 };
6753 
6754 /**
6755  * enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason - connection request failed reasons
6756  * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS: Maximum number of clients that can be
6757  *	handled by the AP is reached.
6758  * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT: Connection request is rejected due to ACL.
6759  */
6760 enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason {
6761 	NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS,
6762 	NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT,
6763 };
6764 
6765 /**
6766  * enum nl80211_timeout_reason - timeout reasons
6767  *
6768  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED: Timeout reason unspecified.
6769  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN: Scan (AP discovery) timed out.
6770  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH: Authentication timed out.
6771  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC: Association timed out.
6772  */
6773 enum nl80211_timeout_reason {
6774 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED,
6775 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN,
6776 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH,
6777 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC,
6778 };
6779 
6780 /**
6781  * enum nl80211_scan_flags -  scan request control flags
6782  *
6783  * Scan request control flags are used to control the handling
6784  * of NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN
6785  * requests.
6786  *
6787  * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN, NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER, and
6788  * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY flags are exclusive of each other, i.e., only
6789  * one of them can be used in the request.
6790  *
6791  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY: scan request has low priority
6792  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH: flush cache before scanning
6793  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP: force a scan even if the interface is configured
6794  *	as AP and the beaconing has already been configured. This attribute is
6795  *	dangerous because will destroy stations performance as a lot of frames
6796  *	will be lost while scanning off-channel, therefore it must be used only
6797  *	when really needed
6798  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR: use a random MAC address for this scan (or
6799  *	for scheduled scan: a different one for every scan iteration). When the
6800  *	flag is set, depending on device capabilities the @NL80211_ATTR_MAC and
6801  *	@NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes may also be given in which case only
6802  *	the masked bits will be preserved from the MAC address and the remainder
6803  *	randomised. If the attributes are not given full randomisation (46 bits,
6804  *	locally administered 1, multicast 0) is assumed.
6805  *	This flag must not be requested when the feature isn't supported, check
6806  *	the nl80211 feature flags for the device.
6807  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: fill the dwell time in the FILS
6808  *	request parameters IE in the probe request
6809  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: accept broadcast probe responses
6810  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: send probe request frames at
6811  *	rate of at least 5.5M. In case non-OCE AP is discovered in the channel,
6812  *	only the first probe req in the channel will be sent in high rate.
6813  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: allow probe request
6814  *	tx deferral (dot11FILSProbeDelay shall be set to 15ms)
6815  *	and suppression (if it has received a broadcast Probe Response frame,
6816  *	Beacon frame or FILS Discovery frame from an AP that the STA considers
6817  *	a suitable candidate for (re-)association - suitable in terms of
6818  *	SSID and/or RSSI.
6819  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN: Span corresponds to the total time taken to
6820  *	accomplish the scan. Thus, this flag intends the driver to perform the
6821  *	scan request with lesser span/duration. It is specific to the driver
6822  *	implementations on how this is accomplished. Scan accuracy may get
6823  *	impacted with this flag.
6824  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER: This flag intends the scan attempts to consume
6825  *	optimal possible power. Drivers can resort to their specific means to
6826  *	optimize the power. Scan accuracy may get impacted with this flag.
6827  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY: Accuracy here intends to the extent of scan
6828  *	results obtained. Thus HIGH_ACCURACY scan flag aims to get maximum
6829  *	possible scan results. This flag hints the driver to use the best
6830  *	possible scan configuration to improve the accuracy in scanning.
6831  *	Latency and power use may get impacted with this flag.
6832  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN: randomize the sequence number in probe
6833  *	request frames from this scan to avoid correlation/tracking being
6834  *	possible.
6835  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: minimize probe request content to
6836  *	only have supported rates and no additional capabilities (unless
6837  *	added by userspace explicitly.)
6838  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ: report scan results with
6839  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ. This also means
6840  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES will not be included.
6841  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_COLOCATED_6GHZ: scan for collocated APs reported by
6842  *	2.4/5 GHz APs. When the flag is set, the scan logic will use the
6843  *	information from the RNR element found in beacons/probe responses
6844  *	received on the 2.4/5 GHz channels to actively scan only the 6GHz
6845  *	channels on which APs are expected to be found. Note that when not set,
6846  *	the scan logic would scan all 6GHz channels, but since transmission of
6847  *	probe requests on non-PSC channels is limited, it is highly likely that
6848  *	these channels would passively be scanned. Also note that when the flag
6849  *	is set, in addition to the colocated APs, PSC channels would also be
6850  *	scanned if the user space has asked for it.
6851  */
6852 enum nl80211_scan_flags {
6853 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY				= 1<<0,
6854 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH					= 1<<1,
6855 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP					= 1<<2,
6856 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR				= 1<<3,
6857 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME			= 1<<4,
6858 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP		= 1<<5,
6859 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE		= 1<<6,
6860 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION	= 1<<7,
6861 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN				= 1<<8,
6862 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER				= 1<<9,
6863 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY				= 1<<10,
6864 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN				= 1<<11,
6865 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT			= 1<<12,
6866 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ				= 1<<13,
6867 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_COLOCATED_6GHZ			= 1<<14,
6868 };
6869 
6870 /**
6871  * enum nl80211_acl_policy - access control policy
6872  *
6873  * Access control policy is applied on a MAC list set by
6874  * %NL80211_CMD_START_AP and %NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL, to
6875  * be used with %NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY.
6876  *
6877  * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED: Deny stations which are
6878  *	listed in ACL, i.e. allow all the stations which are not listed
6879  *	in ACL to authenticate.
6880  * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED: Allow the stations which are listed
6881  *	in ACL, i.e. deny all the stations which are not listed in ACL.
6882  */
6883 enum nl80211_acl_policy {
6884 	NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED,
6885 	NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED,
6886 };
6887 
6888 /**
6889  * enum nl80211_smps_mode - SMPS mode
6890  *
6891  * Requested SMPS mode (for AP mode)
6892  *
6893  * @NL80211_SMPS_OFF: SMPS off (use all antennas).
6894  * @NL80211_SMPS_STATIC: static SMPS (use a single antenna)
6895  * @NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic smps (start with a single antenna and
6896  *	turn on other antennas after CTS/RTS).
6897  * @__NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST: internal
6898  * @NL80211_SMPS_MAX: highest used enumeration
6899  */
6900 enum nl80211_smps_mode {
6901 	NL80211_SMPS_OFF,
6902 	NL80211_SMPS_STATIC,
6903 	NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
6904 
6905 	__NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST,
6906 	NL80211_SMPS_MAX = __NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST - 1
6907 };
6908 
6909 /**
6910  * enum nl80211_radar_event - type of radar event for DFS operation
6911  *
6912  * Type of event to be used with NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT to inform userspace
6913  * about detected radars or success of the channel available check (CAC)
6914  *
6915  * @NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED: A radar pattern has been detected. The channel is
6916  *	now unusable.
6917  * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED: Channel Availability Check has been finished,
6918  *	the channel is now available.
6919  * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED: Channel Availability Check has been aborted, no
6920  *	change to the channel status.
6921  * @NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED: The Non-Occupancy Period for this channel is
6922  *	over, channel becomes usable.
6923  * @NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED: Channel Availability Check done on this
6924  *	non-operating channel is expired and no longer valid. New CAC must
6925  *	be done on this channel before starting the operation. This is not
6926  *	applicable for ETSI dfs domain where pre-CAC is valid for ever.
6927  * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED: Channel Availability Check has been started,
6928  *	should be generated by HW if NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD is enabled.
6929  */
6930 enum nl80211_radar_event {
6931 	NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED,
6932 	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED,
6933 	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED,
6934 	NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED,
6935 	NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED,
6936 	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED,
6937 };
6938 
6939 /**
6940  * enum nl80211_dfs_state - DFS states for channels
6941  *
6942  * Channel states used by the DFS code.
6943  *
6944  * @NL80211_DFS_USABLE: The channel can be used, but channel availability
6945  *	check (CAC) must be performed before using it for AP or IBSS.
6946  * @NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE: A radar has been detected on this channel, it
6947  *	is therefore marked as not available.
6948  * @NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE: The channel has been CAC checked and is available.
6949  */
6950 enum nl80211_dfs_state {
6951 	NL80211_DFS_USABLE,
6952 	NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE,
6953 	NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE,
6954 };
6955 
6956 /**
6957  * enum nl80211_protocol_features - nl80211 protocol features
6958  * @NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: nl80211 supports splitting
6959  *	wiphy dumps (if requested by the application with the attribute
6960  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP. Also supported is filtering the
6961  *	wiphy dump by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX or
6962  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WDEV.
6963  */
6964 enum nl80211_protocol_features {
6965 	NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP =	1 << 0,
6966 };
6967 
6968 /**
6969  * enum nl80211_crit_proto_id - nl80211 critical protocol identifiers
6970  *
6971  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC: protocol unspecified.
6972  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP: BOOTP or DHCPv6 protocol.
6973  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL: EAPOL protocol.
6974  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA: APIPA protocol.
6975  * @NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO: must be kept last.
6976  */
6977 enum nl80211_crit_proto_id {
6978 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC,
6979 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP,
6980 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL,
6981 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA,
6982 	/* add other protocols before this one */
6983 	NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO
6984 };
6985 
6986 /* maximum duration for critical protocol measures */
6987 #define NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_MAX_DURATION		5000 /* msec */
6988 
6989 /**
6990  * enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags - flags for received management frame.
6991  *
6992  * Used by cfg80211_rx_mgmt()
6993  *
6994  * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED: frame was answered by device/driver.
6995  * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH: Host driver intends to offload
6996  *	the authentication. Exclusively defined for host drivers that
6997  *	advertises the SME functionality but would like the userspace
6998  *	to handle certain authentication algorithms (e.g. SAE).
6999  */
7000 enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags {
7001 	NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED = 1 << 0,
7002 	NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH = 1 << 1,
7003 };
7004 
7005 /*
7006  * If this flag is unset, the lower 24 bits are an OUI, if set
7007  * a Linux nl80211 vendor ID is used (no such IDs are allocated
7008  * yet, so that's not valid so far)
7009  */
7010 #define NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX	0x80000000
7011 
7012 /**
7013  * struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info - vendor command data
7014  * @vendor_id: If the %NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX flag is clear, then the
7015  *	value is a 24-bit OUI; if it is set then a separately allocated ID
7016  *	may be used, but no such IDs are allocated yet. New IDs should be
7017  *	added to this file when needed.
7018  * @subcmd: sub-command ID for the command
7019  */
7020 struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info {
7021 	__u32 vendor_id;
7022 	__u32 subcmd;
7023 };
7024 
7025 /**
7026  * enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability - TDLS peer flags.
7027  *
7028  * Used by tdls_mgmt() to determine which conditional elements need
7029  * to be added to TDLS Setup frames.
7030  *
7031  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT: TDLS peer is HT capable.
7032  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT: TDLS peer is VHT capable.
7033  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM: TDLS peer is WMM capable.
7034  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HE: TDLS peer is HE capable.
7035  */
7036 enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability {
7037 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT = 1<<0,
7038 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT = 1<<1,
7039 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM = 1<<2,
7040 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HE = 1<<3,
7041 };
7042 
7043 /**
7044  * enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan - scanning plan for scheduled scan
7045  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
7046  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: interval between scan iterations. In
7047  *	seconds (u32).
7048  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: number of scan iterations in this
7049  *	scan plan (u32). The last scan plan must not specify this attribute
7050  *	because it will run infinitely. A value of zero is invalid as it will
7051  *	make the scan plan meaningless.
7052  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX: highest scheduled scan plan attribute number
7053  *	currently defined
7054  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST: internal use
7055  */
7056 enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan {
7057 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID,
7058 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL,
7059 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS,
7060 
7061 	/* keep last */
7062 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST,
7063 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX =
7064 		__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST - 1
7065 };
7066 
7067 /**
7068  * struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust - RSSI adjustment parameters.
7069  *
7070  * @band: band of BSS that must match for RSSI value adjustment. The value
7071  *	of this field is according to &enum nl80211_band.
7072  * @delta: value used to adjust the RSSI value of matching BSS in dB.
7073  */
7074 struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust {
7075 	__u8 band;
7076 	__s8 delta;
7077 } __attribute__((packed));
7078 
7079 /**
7080  * enum nl80211_bss_select_attr - attributes for bss selection.
7081  *
7082  * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID: reserved.
7083  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI: Flag indicating only RSSI-based BSS selection
7084  *	is requested.
7085  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF: attribute indicating BSS
7086  *	selection should be done such that the specified band is preferred.
7087  *	When there are multiple BSS-es in the preferred band, the driver
7088  *	shall use RSSI-based BSS selection as a second step. The value of
7089  *	this attribute is according to &enum nl80211_band (u32).
7090  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for
7091  *	BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
7092  *	RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure
7093  *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
7094  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX: highest bss select attribute number.
7095  * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use.
7096  *
7097  * One and only one of these attributes are found within %NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT
7098  * for %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. It specifies the required BSS selection behaviour
7099  * which the driver shall use.
7100  */
7101 enum nl80211_bss_select_attr {
7102 	__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID,
7103 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI,
7104 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF,
7105 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST,
7106 
7107 	/* keep last */
7108 	__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
7109 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
7110 };
7111 
7112 /**
7113  * enum nl80211_nan_function_type - NAN function type
7114  *
7115  * Defines the function type of a NAN function
7116  *
7117  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH: function is publish
7118  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE: function is subscribe
7119  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP: function is follow-up
7120  * @__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST: internal use
7121  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_MAX_TYPE: internal use
7122  */
7123 enum nl80211_nan_function_type {
7124 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH,
7125 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE,
7126 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP,
7127 
7128 	/* keep last */
7129 	__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST,
7130 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_MAX_TYPE = __NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST - 1,
7131 };
7132 
7133 /**
7134  * enum nl80211_nan_publish_type - NAN publish tx type
7135  *
7136  * Defines how to send publish Service Discovery Frames
7137  *
7138  * @NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is solicited
7139  * @NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is unsolicited
7140  */
7141 enum nl80211_nan_publish_type {
7142 	NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 0,
7143 	NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 1,
7144 };
7145 
7146 /**
7147  * enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason - NAN functions termination reason
7148  *
7149  * Defines termination reasons of a NAN function
7150  *
7151  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST: requested by user
7152  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED: timeout
7153  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR: errored
7154  */
7155 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason {
7156 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST,
7157 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED,
7158 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR,
7159 };
7160 
7161 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN 6
7162 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_SPEC_INFO_MAX_LEN 0xff
7163 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF_MAX_LEN 0xff
7164 
7165 /**
7166  * enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes - NAN function attributes
7167  * @__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID: invalid
7168  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type (u8).
7169  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID: 6 bytes of the service ID hash as
7170  *	specified in NAN spec. This is a binary attribute.
7171  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE: relevant if the function's type is
7172  *	publish. Defines the transmission type for the publish Service Discovery
7173  *	Frame, see &enum nl80211_nan_publish_type. Its type is u8.
7174  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST: relevant if the function is a solicited
7175  *	publish. Should the solicited publish Service Discovery Frame be sent to
7176  *	the NAN Broadcast address. This is a flag.
7177  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE: relevant if the function's type is
7178  *	subscribe. Is the subscribe active. This is a flag.
7179  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID: relevant if the function's type is follow up.
7180  *	The instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is u8.
7181  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID: relevant if the function's type
7182  *	is follow up. This is a u8.
7183  *	The requester instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame.
7184  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST: the MAC address of the recipient of the
7185  *	follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is a binary attribute.
7186  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE: is this function limited for devices in a
7187  *	close range. The range itself (RSSI) is defined by the device.
7188  *	This is a flag.
7189  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL: strictly positive number of DWs this function should
7190  *	stay active. If not present infinite TTL is assumed. This is a u32.
7191  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO: array of bytes describing the service
7192  *	specific info. This is a binary attribute.
7193  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF: Service Receive Filter. This is a nested attribute.
7194  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes.
7195  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER: Receive Matching filter. This is a nested
7196  *	attribute. It is a list of binary values.
7197  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER: Transmit Matching filter. This is a
7198  *	nested attribute. It is a list of binary values.
7199  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID: The instance ID of the function.
7200  *	Its type is u8 and it cannot be 0.
7201  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON: NAN function termination reason.
7202  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason.
7203  *
7204  * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR: internal
7205  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN function attribute
7206  */
7207 enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes {
7208 	__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID,
7209 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE,
7210 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID,
7211 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE,
7212 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST,
7213 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE,
7214 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID,
7215 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID,
7216 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST,
7217 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE,
7218 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL,
7219 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO,
7220 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF,
7221 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER,
7222 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER,
7223 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID,
7224 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON,
7225 
7226 	/* keep last */
7227 	NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR,
7228 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR - 1
7229 };
7230 
7231 /**
7232  * enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes - NAN Service Response filter attributes
7233  * @__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID: invalid
7234  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE: present if the include bit of the SRF set.
7235  *	This is a flag.
7236  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF: Bloom Filter. Present if and only if
7237  *	%NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS isn't present. This attribute is binary.
7238  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX: index of the Bloom Filter. Mandatory if
7239  *	%NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF is present. This is a u8.
7240  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS: list of MAC addresses for the SRF. Present if
7241  *	and only if %NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF isn't present. This is a nested
7242  *	attribute. Each nested attribute is a MAC address.
7243  * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR: internal
7244  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN SRF attribute
7245  */
7246 enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes {
7247 	__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID,
7248 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE,
7249 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF,
7250 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX,
7251 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS,
7252 
7253 	/* keep last */
7254 	NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR,
7255 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR - 1,
7256 };
7257 
7258 /**
7259  * enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes - NAN match attributes
7260  * @__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID: invalid
7261  * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL: the local function that had the
7262  *	match. This is a nested attribute.
7263  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes.
7264  * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER: the peer function
7265  *	that caused the match. This is a nested attribute.
7266  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes.
7267  *
7268  * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR: internal
7269  * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN match attribute
7270  */
7271 enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes {
7272 	__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID,
7273 	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL,
7274 	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER,
7275 
7276 	/* keep last */
7277 	NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR,
7278 	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR - 1
7279 };
7280 
7281 /**
7282  * enum nl80211_external_auth_action - Action to perform with external
7283  *     authentication request. Used by NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION.
7284  * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START: Start the authentication.
7285  * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT: Abort the ongoing authentication.
7286  */
7287 enum nl80211_external_auth_action {
7288 	NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START,
7289 	NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT,
7290 };
7291 
7292 /**
7293  * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes - fine timing measurement
7294  *	responder attributes
7295  * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7296  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED: FTM responder is enabled
7297  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: The content of Measurement Report Element
7298  *	(9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 8 - LCI (9.4.2.22.10),
7299  *	i.e. starting with the measurement token
7300  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC: The content of Measurement Report Element
7301  *	(9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 11 - Civic (Section 9.4.2.22.13),
7302  *	i.e. starting with the measurement token
7303  * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7304  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest FTM responder attribute.
7305  */
7306 enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes {
7307 	__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7308 
7309 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED,
7310 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI,
7311 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC,
7312 
7313 	/* keep last */
7314 	__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST,
7315 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7316 };
7317 
7318 /*
7319  * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
7320  *
7321  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS
7322  * when getting FTM responder statistics.
7323  *
7324  * @__NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
7325  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which all frames
7326  *	were ssfully answered (u32)
7327  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which part of the
7328  *	frames were successfully answered (u32)
7329  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM: number of failed FTM sessions (u32)
7330  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM: number of ASAP sessions (u32)
7331  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM: number of non-ASAP sessions (u32)
7332  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC: total sessions durations - gives an
7333  *	indication of how much time the responder was busy (u64, msec)
7334  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of unknown FTM triggers -
7335  *	triggers from initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation
7336  *	phase with the responder (u32)
7337  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM: number of FTM reschedule requests
7338  *	- initiator asks for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled
7339  *	FTM slot (u32)
7340  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of FTM triggers out of
7341  *	scheduled window (u32)
7342  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD: used for padding, ignore
7343  * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal
7344  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX: highest possible FTM responder stats attribute
7345  */
7346 enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats {
7347 	__NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID,
7348 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM,
7349 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM,
7350 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM,
7351 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM,
7352 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM,
7353 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC,
7354 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM,
7355 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM,
7356 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM,
7357 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD,
7358 
7359 	/* keep last */
7360 	__NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST,
7361 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST - 1
7362 };
7363 
7364 /**
7365  * enum nl80211_preamble - frame preamble types
7366  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY: legacy (HR/DSSS, OFDM, ERP PHY) preamble
7367  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT: HT preamble
7368  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT: VHT preamble
7369  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG: DMG preamble
7370  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_HE: HE preamble
7371  */
7372 enum nl80211_preamble {
7373 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY,
7374 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT,
7375 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT,
7376 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG,
7377 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_HE,
7378 };
7379 
7380 /**
7381  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type - peer measurement types
7382  * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID: invalid/unused, needed as we use
7383  *	these numbers also for attributes
7384  *
7385  * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM: flight time measurement
7386  *
7387  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES: internal
7388  * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX: highest type number
7389  */
7390 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type {
7391 	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID,
7392 
7393 	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM,
7394 
7395 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES,
7396 	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES - 1
7397 };
7398 
7399 /**
7400  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status - peer measurement status
7401  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS: measurement completed successfully
7402  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED: measurement was locally refused
7403  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT: measurement timed out
7404  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE: measurement failed, a type-dependent
7405  *	reason may be available in the response data
7406  */
7407 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status {
7408 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS,
7409 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED,
7410 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT,
7411 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE,
7412 };
7413 
7414 /**
7415  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req - peer measurement request attributes
7416  * @__NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7417  *
7418  * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement
7419  *	type-specific request data inside. The attributes used are from the
7420  *	enums named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_req.
7421  * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF: include AP TSF timestamp, if supported
7422  *	(flag attribute)
7423  *
7424  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS: internal
7425  * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7426  */
7427 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req {
7428 	__NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID,
7429 
7430 	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA,
7431 	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF,
7432 
7433 	/* keep last */
7434 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS,
7435 	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS - 1
7436 };
7437 
7438 /**
7439  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp - peer measurement response attributes
7440  * @__NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7441  *
7442  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement
7443  *	type-specific results inside. The attributes used are from the enums
7444  *	named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_resp.
7445  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS: u32 value with the measurement status
7446  *	(using values from &enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status.)
7447  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME: host time (%CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the
7448  *	result was measured; this value is not expected to be accurate to
7449  *	more than 20ms. (u64, nanoseconds)
7450  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF: TSF of the AP that the interface
7451  *	doing the measurement is connected to when the result was measured.
7452  *	This shall be accurately reported if supported and requested
7453  *	(u64, usec)
7454  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL: If results are sent to the host partially
7455  *	(*e.g. with FTM per-burst data) this flag will be cleared on all but
7456  *	the last result; if all results are combined it's set on the single
7457  *	result.
7458  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD: padding for 64-bit attributes, ignore
7459  *
7460  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS: internal
7461  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7462  */
7463 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp {
7464 	__NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7465 
7466 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA,
7467 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS,
7468 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME,
7469 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF,
7470 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL,
7471 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD,
7472 
7473 	/* keep last */
7474 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS,
7475 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS - 1
7476 };
7477 
7478 /**
7479  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs - peer attributes for measurement
7480  * @__NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7481  *
7482  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR: peer's MAC address
7483  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN: channel definition, nested, using top-level
7484  *	attributes like %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ etc.
7485  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ: This is a nested attribute indexed by
7486  *	measurement type, with attributes from the
7487  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req inside.
7488  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP: This is a nested attribute indexed by
7489  *	measurement type, with attributes from the
7490  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp inside.
7491  *
7492  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS: internal
7493  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7494  */
7495 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs {
7496 	__NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID,
7497 
7498 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR,
7499 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN,
7500 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ,
7501 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP,
7502 
7503 	/* keep last */
7504 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS,
7505 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS - 1,
7506 };
7507 
7508 /**
7509  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs - peer measurement attributes
7510  * @__NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7511  *
7512  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS: u32 attribute used for capability
7513  *	advertisement only, indicates the maximum number of peers
7514  *	measurements can be done with in a single request
7515  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF: flag attribute in capability
7516  *	indicating that the connected AP's TSF can be reported in
7517  *	measurement results
7518  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR: flag attribute in capability
7519  *	indicating that MAC address randomization is supported.
7520  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA: capabilities reported by the device,
7521  *	this contains a nesting indexed by measurement type, and
7522  *	type-specific capabilities inside, which are from the enums
7523  *	named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_capa.
7524  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS: nested attribute, the nesting index is
7525  *	meaningless, just a list of peers to measure with, with the
7526  *	sub-attributes taken from
7527  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs.
7528  *
7529  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR: internal
7530  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7531  */
7532 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs {
7533 	__NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID,
7534 
7535 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS,
7536 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF,
7537 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR,
7538 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA,
7539 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS,
7540 
7541 	/* keep last */
7542 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR,
7543 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR - 1
7544 };
7545 
7546 /**
7547  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa - FTM capabilities
7548  * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7549  *
7550  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP: flag attribute indicating ASAP mode
7551  *	is supported
7552  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP: flag attribute indicating non-ASAP
7553  *	mode is supported
7554  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI: flag attribute indicating if LCI
7555  *	data can be requested during the measurement
7556  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC: flag attribute indicating if civic
7557  *	location data can be requested during the measurement
7558  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES: u32 bitmap attribute of bits
7559  *	from &enum nl80211_preamble.
7560  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS: bitmap of values from
7561  *	&enum nl80211_chan_width indicating the supported channel
7562  *	bandwidths for FTM. Note that a higher channel bandwidth may be
7563  *	configured to allow for other measurements types with different
7564  *	bandwidth requirement in the same measurement.
7565  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT: u32 attribute indicating
7566  *	the maximum bursts exponent that can be used (if not present anything
7567  *	is valid)
7568  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST: u32 attribute indicating
7569  *	the maximum FTMs per burst (if not present anything is valid)
7570  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED: flag attribute indicating if
7571  *	trigger based ranging measurement is supported
7572  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED: flag attribute indicating
7573  *	if non-trigger-based ranging measurement is supported
7574  *
7575  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR: internal
7576  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7577  */
7578 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa {
7579 	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID,
7580 
7581 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP,
7582 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP,
7583 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI,
7584 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC,
7585 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES,
7586 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS,
7587 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT,
7588 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST,
7589 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED,
7590 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED,
7591 
7592 	/* keep last */
7593 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR,
7594 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR - 1
7595 };
7596 
7597 /**
7598  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req - FTM request attributes
7599  * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7600  *
7601  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP: ASAP mode requested (flag)
7602  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE: preamble type (see
7603  *	&enum nl80211_preamble), optional for DMG (u32)
7604  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: number of bursts exponent as in
7605  *	802.11-2016 9.4.2.168 "Fine Timing Measurement Parameters element"
7606  *	(u8, 0-15, optional with default 15 i.e. "no preference")
7607  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD: interval between bursts in units
7608  *	of 100ms (u16, optional with default 0)
7609  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: burst duration, as in 802.11-2016
7610  *	Table 9-257 "Burst Duration field encoding" (u8, 0-15, optional with
7611  *	default 15 i.e. "no preference")
7612  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: number of successful FTM frames
7613  *	requested per burst
7614  *	(u8, 0-31, optional with default 0 i.e. "no preference")
7615  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES: number of FTMR frame retries
7616  *	(u8, default 3)
7617  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI: request LCI data (flag)
7618  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC: request civic location data
7619  *	(flag)
7620  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED: request trigger based ranging
7621  *	measurement (flag).
7622  *	This attribute and %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED are
7623  *	mutually exclusive.
7624  *      if neither %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED nor
7625  *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set, EDCA based
7626  *	ranging will be used.
7627  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED: request non-trigger-based
7628  *	ranging measurement (flag)
7629  *	This attribute and %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED are
7630  *	mutually exclusive.
7631  *      if neither %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED nor
7632  *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set, EDCA based
7633  *	ranging will be used.
7634  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_LMR_FEEDBACK: negotiate for LMR feedback. Only
7635  *	valid if either %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED or
7636  *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set.
7637  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BSS_COLOR: optional. The BSS color of the
7638  *	responder. Only valid if %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED
7639  *	or %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED is set.
7640  *
7641  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR: internal
7642  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7643  */
7644 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req {
7645 	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID,
7646 
7647 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP,
7648 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE,
7649 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP,
7650 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD,
7651 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION,
7652 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST,
7653 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES,
7654 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI,
7655 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC,
7656 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED,
7657 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED,
7658 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_LMR_FEEDBACK,
7659 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BSS_COLOR,
7660 
7661 	/* keep last */
7662 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR,
7663 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR - 1
7664 };
7665 
7666 /**
7667  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons - FTM failure reasons
7668  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified failure, not used
7669  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE: no response from the FTM responder
7670  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED: FTM responder rejected measurement
7671  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL: we already know the peer is
7672  *	on a different channel, so can't measure (if we didn't know, we'd
7673  *	try and get no response)
7674  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE: peer can't actually do FTM
7675  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP: invalid T1/T4 timestamps
7676  *	received
7677  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY: peer reports busy, you may retry
7678  *	later (see %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME)
7679  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS: parameters were changed
7680  *	by the peer and are no longer supported
7681  */
7682 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons {
7683 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED,
7684 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE,
7685 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED,
7686 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL,
7687 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE,
7688 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP,
7689 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
7690 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS,
7691 };
7692 
7693 /**
7694  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp - FTM response attributes
7695  * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7696  *
7697  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON: FTM-specific failure reason
7698  *	(u32, optional)
7699  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX: optional, if bursts are reported
7700  *	as separate results then it will be the burst index 0...(N-1) and
7701  *	the top level will indicate partial results (u32)
7702  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS: number of FTM Request frames
7703  *	transmitted (u32, optional)
7704  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES: number of FTM Request frames
7705  *	that were acknowledged (u32, optional)
7706  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME: retry time received from the
7707  *	busy peer (u32, seconds)
7708  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: actual number of bursts exponent
7709  *	used by the responder (similar to request, u8)
7710  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: actual burst duration used by
7711  *	the responder (similar to request, u8)
7712  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: actual FTMs per burst used
7713  *	by the responder (similar to request, u8)
7714  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG: average RSSI across all FTM action
7715  *	frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm)
7716  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD: RSSI spread across all FTM action
7717  *	frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm)
7718  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE: bitrate we used for the response to the
7719  *	FTM action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info
7720  *	attributes)
7721  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE: bitrate the responder used for the FTM
7722  *	action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info attrs)
7723  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG: average RTT (s64, picoseconds, optional
7724  *	but one of RTT/DIST must be present)
7725  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE: RTT variance (u64, ps^2, note that
7726  *	standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional)
7727  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD: RTT spread (u64, picoseconds,
7728  *	optional)
7729  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG: average distance (s64, mm, optional
7730  *	but one of RTT/DIST must be present)
7731  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE: distance variance (u64, mm^2, note
7732  *	that standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional)
7733  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD: distance spread (u64, mm, optional)
7734  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: LCI data from peer (binary, optional);
7735  *	this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016
7736  *	9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement
7737  *	Type 8.
7738  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC: civic location data from peer
7739  *	(binary, optional);
7740  *	this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016
7741  *	9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement
7742  *	Type 11.
7743  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD: ignore, for u64/s64 padding only
7744  *
7745  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR: internal
7746  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7747  */
7748 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp {
7749 	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7750 
7751 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON,
7752 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX,
7753 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS,
7754 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES,
7755 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME,
7756 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP,
7757 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION,
7758 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST,
7759 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG,
7760 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD,
7761 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE,
7762 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE,
7763 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG,
7764 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE,
7765 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD,
7766 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG,
7767 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE,
7768 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD,
7769 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI,
7770 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC,
7771 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD,
7772 
7773 	/* keep last */
7774 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR,
7775 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR - 1
7776 };
7777 
7778 /**
7779  * enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes - OBSS packet detection attributes
7780  * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7781  *
7782  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET: the OBSS PD minimum tx power offset.
7783  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET: the OBSS PD maximum tx power offset.
7784  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_NON_SRG_MAX_OFFSET: the non-SRG OBSS PD maximum
7785  *	tx power offset.
7786  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_BSS_COLOR_BITMAP: bitmap that indicates the BSS color
7787  *	values used by members of the SRG.
7788  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_PARTIAL_BSSID_BITMAP: bitmap that indicates the partial
7789  *	BSSID values used by members of the SRG.
7790  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_SR_CTRL: The SR Control field of SRP element.
7791  *
7792  * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7793  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX: highest OBSS PD attribute.
7794  */
7795 enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes {
7796 	__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID,
7797 
7798 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET,
7799 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET,
7800 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_NON_SRG_MAX_OFFSET,
7801 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_BSS_COLOR_BITMAP,
7802 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_PARTIAL_BSSID_BITMAP,
7803 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_SR_CTRL,
7804 
7805 	/* keep last */
7806 	__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST,
7807 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7808 };
7809 
7810 /**
7811  * enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes - BSS Color attributes
7812  * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7813  *
7814  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR: the current BSS Color.
7815  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED: is BSS coloring disabled.
7816  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL: the AID equation to be used..
7817  *
7818  * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7819  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX: highest BSS Color attribute.
7820  */
7821 enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes {
7822 	__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID,
7823 
7824 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR,
7825 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED,
7826 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL,
7827 
7828 	/* keep last */
7829 	__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST,
7830 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7831 };
7832 
7833 /**
7834  * enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes - interface type AKM attributes
7835  * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7836  *
7837  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag
7838  *	attribute for each interface type that supports AKM suites specified in
7839  *	%NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES
7840  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES: an array of u32. Used to indicate supported
7841  *	AKM suites for the specified interface types.
7842  *
7843  * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7844  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX: highest interface type AKM attribute.
7845  */
7846 enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes {
7847 	__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID,
7848 
7849 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES,
7850 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES,
7851 
7852 	/* keep last */
7853 	__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST,
7854 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7855 };
7856 
7857 /**
7858  * enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes - FILS discovery configuration
7859  * from IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
7860  *
7861  * @__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7862  *
7863  * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MIN: Minimum packet interval (u32, TU).
7864  *	Allowed range: 0..10000 (TU = Time Unit)
7865  * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MAX: Maximum packet interval (u32, TU).
7866  *	Allowed range: 0..10000 (TU = Time Unit). If set to 0, the feature is disabled.
7867  * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_TMPL: Template data for FILS discovery action
7868  *	frame including the headers.
7869  *
7870  * @__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7871  * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
7872  */
7873 enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes {
7874 	__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INVALID,
7875 
7876 	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MIN,
7877 	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MAX,
7878 	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_TMPL,
7879 
7880 	/* keep last */
7881 	__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST,
7882 	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST - 1
7883 };
7884 
7885 /*
7886  * FILS discovery template minimum length with action frame headers and
7887  * mandatory fields.
7888  */
7889 #define NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_TMPL_MIN_LEN 42
7890 
7891 /**
7892  * enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes - Unsolicited broadcast probe
7893  *	response configuration. Applicable only in 6GHz.
7894  *
7895  * @__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7896  *
7897  * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INT: Maximum packet interval (u32, TU).
7898  *	Allowed range: 0..20 (TU = Time Unit). IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0
7899  *	26.17.2.3.2 (AP behavior for fast passive scanning). If set to 0, the feature is
7900  *	disabled.
7901  * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_TMPL: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
7902  *	frame template (binary).
7903  *
7904  * @__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7905  * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
7906  */
7907 enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes {
7908 	__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7909 
7910 	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INT,
7911 	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_TMPL,
7912 
7913 	/* keep last */
7914 	__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST,
7915 	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_MAX =
7916 		__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST - 1
7917 };
7918 
7919 /**
7920  * enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism - The mechanism(s) allowed for SAE PWE
7921  *	derivation. Applicable only when WPA3-Personal SAE authentication is
7922  *	used.
7923  *
7924  * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED: not specified, used internally to indicate that
7925  *	attribute is not present from userspace.
7926  * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK: hunting-and-pecking loop only
7927  * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT: hash-to-element only
7928  * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH: both hunting-and-pecking loop and hash-to-element
7929  *	can be used.
7930  */
7931 enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism {
7932 	NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED,
7933 	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK,
7934 	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT,
7935 	NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH,
7936 };
7937 
7938 /**
7939  * enum nl80211_sar_type - type of SAR specs
7940  *
7941  * @NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER: power limitation specified in 0.25dBm unit
7942  *
7943  * @NUM_NL80211_SAR_TYPE: internal
7944  */
7945 enum nl80211_sar_type {
7946 	NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER,
7947 
7948 	/* add new type here */
7949 
7950 	/* Keep last */
7951 	NUM_NL80211_SAR_TYPE,
7952 };
7953 
7954 /**
7955  * enum nl80211_sar_attrs - Attributes for SAR spec
7956  *
7957  * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7958  *
7959  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_TYPE: the SAR type as defined in &enum nl80211_sar_type.
7960  *
7961  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS: Nested array of SAR power
7962  *	limit specifications. Each specification contains a set
7963  *	of %nl80211_sar_specs_attrs.
7964  *
7965  *	For SET operation, it contains array of %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER
7966  *	and %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX.
7967  *
7968  *	For sar_capa dump, it contains array of
7969  *	%NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ
7970  *	and %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ.
7971  *
7972  * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7973  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_MAX: highest sar attribute
7974  *
7975  * These attributes are used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPEC
7976  */
7977 enum nl80211_sar_attrs {
7978 	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_INVALID,
7979 
7980 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_TYPE,
7981 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS,
7982 
7983 	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST,
7984 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7985 };
7986 
7987 /**
7988  * enum nl80211_sar_specs_attrs - Attributes for SAR power limit specs
7989  *
7990  * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_INVALID: Invalid
7991  *
7992  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER: Required (s32)value to specify the actual
7993  *	power limit value in units of 0.25 dBm if type is
7994  *	NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER. (i.e., a value of 44 represents 11 dBm).
7995  *	0 means userspace doesn't have SAR limitation on this associated range.
7996  *
7997  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX: Required (u32) value to specify the
7998  *	index of exported freq range table and the associated power limitation
7999  *	is applied to this range.
8000  *
8001  *	Userspace isn't required to set all the ranges advertised by WLAN driver,
8002  *	and userspace can skip some certain ranges. These skipped ranges don't
8003  *	have SAR limitations, and they are same as setting the
8004  *	%NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER to any unreasonable high value because any
8005  *	value higher than regulatory allowed value just means SAR power
8006  *	limitation is removed, but it's required to set at least one range.
8007  *	It's not allowed to set duplicated range in one SET operation.
8008  *
8009  *	Every SET operation overwrites previous SET operation.
8010  *
8011  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ: Required (u32) value to specify the start
8012  *	frequency of this range edge when registering SAR capability to wiphy.
8013  *	It's not a channel center frequency. The unit is kHz.
8014  *
8015  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ: Required (u32) value to specify the end
8016  *	frequency of this range edge when registering SAR capability to wiphy.
8017  *	It's not a channel center frequency. The unit is kHz.
8018  *
8019  * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST: Internal
8020  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_MAX: highest sar specs attribute
8021  */
8022 enum nl80211_sar_specs_attrs {
8023 	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_INVALID,
8024 
8025 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER,
8026 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX,
8027 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ,
8028 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ,
8029 
8030 	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST,
8031 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_MAX = __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST - 1,
8032 };
8033 
8034 /**
8035  * enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes - multiple BSSID (MBSSID) and enhanced
8036  * multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA) in AP mode.
8037  * Kernel uses some of these attributes to advertise driver's support for
8038  * MBSSID and EMA.
8039  * Remaining attributes should be used by the userspace to configure the
8040  * features.
8041  *
8042  * @__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
8043  *
8044  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_INTERFACES: Used by the kernel to advertise
8045  *	the maximum number of MBSSID interfaces supported by the driver.
8046  *	Driver should indicate MBSSID support by setting
8047  *	wiphy->mbssid_max_interfaces to a value more than or equal to 2.
8048  *
8049  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_EMA_PROFILE_PERIODICITY: Used by the kernel
8050  *	to advertise the maximum profile periodicity supported by the driver
8051  *	if EMA is enabled. Driver should indicate EMA support to the userspace
8052  *	by setting wiphy->ema_max_profile_periodicity to
8053  *	a non-zero value.
8054  *
8055  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INDEX: Mandatory parameter to pass the index of
8056  *	this BSS (u8) in the multiple BSSID set.
8057  *	Value must be set to 0 for the transmitting interface and non-zero for
8058  *	all non-transmitting interfaces. The userspace will be responsible
8059  *	for using unique indices for the interfaces.
8060  *	Range: 0 to wiphy->mbssid_max_interfaces-1.
8061  *
8062  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_IFINDEX: Mandatory parameter for
8063  *	a non-transmitted profile which provides the interface index (u32) of
8064  *	the transmitted profile. The value must match one of the interface
8065  *	indices advertised by the kernel. Optional if the interface being set up
8066  *	is the transmitting one, however, if provided then the value must match
8067  *	the interface index of the same.
8068  *
8069  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA: Flag used to enable EMA AP feature.
8070  *	Setting this flag is permitted only if the driver advertises EMA support
8071  *	by setting wiphy->ema_max_profile_periodicity to non-zero.
8072  *
8073  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_LINK_ID: Link ID of the transmitted profile.
8074  *	This parameter is mandatory when NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG attributes
8075  *	are sent for a non-transmitted profile and if the transmitted profile
8076  *	is part of an MLD. For all other cases this parameter is unnecessary.
8077  *
8078  * @__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST: Internal
8079  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
8080  */
8081 enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes {
8082 	__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID,
8083 
8084 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_INTERFACES,
8085 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_EMA_PROFILE_PERIODICITY,
8086 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INDEX,
8087 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_IFINDEX,
8088 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA,
8089 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_LINK_ID,
8090 
8091 	/* keep last */
8092 	__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST,
8093 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST - 1,
8094 };
8095 
8096 /**
8097  * enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags - AP settings flags
8098  *
8099  * @NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: AP supports external
8100  *	authentication.
8101  * @NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT: Userspace supports SA Query
8102  *	procedures offload to driver. If driver advertises
8103  *	%NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD in AP SME features, userspace shall
8104  *	ignore SA Query procedures and validations when this flag is set by
8105  *	userspace.
8106  */
8107 enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags {
8108 	NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT	= 1 << 0,
8109 	NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT	= 1 << 1,
8110 };
8111 
8112 /**
8113  * enum nl80211_wiphy_radio_attrs - wiphy radio attributes
8114  *
8115  * @__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
8116  *
8117  * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_INDEX: Index of this radio (u32)
8118  * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE: Frequency range supported by this
8119  *	radio. Attribute may be present multiple times.
8120  * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATION: Supported interface
8121  *	combination for this radio. Attribute may be present multiple times
8122  *	and contains attributes defined in &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
8123  * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_ANTENNA_MASK: bitmask (u32) of antennas
8124  *	connected to this radio.
8125  * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_RTS_THRESHOLD: RTS threshold (u32) of this radio.
8126  *
8127  * @__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_LAST: Internal
8128  * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_MAX: Highest attribute
8129  */
8130 enum nl80211_wiphy_radio_attrs {
8131 	__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_INVALID,
8132 
8133 	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_INDEX,
8134 	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE,
8135 	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATION,
8136 	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_ANTENNA_MASK,
8137 	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_RTS_THRESHOLD,
8138 
8139 	/* keep last */
8140 	__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_LAST,
8141 	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_LAST - 1,
8142 };
8143 
8144 /**
8145  * enum nl80211_wiphy_radio_freq_range - wiphy radio frequency range
8146  *
8147  * @__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
8148  *
8149  * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_START: Frequency range start (u32).
8150  *	The unit is kHz.
8151  * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_END: Frequency range end (u32).
8152  *	The unit is kHz.
8153  *
8154  * @__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_LAST: Internal
8155  * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_MAX: Highest attribute
8156  */
8157 enum nl80211_wiphy_radio_freq_range {
8158 	__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_INVALID,
8159 
8160 	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_START,
8161 	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_END,
8162 
8163 	__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_LAST,
8164 	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_LAST - 1,
8165 };
8166 
8167 /**
8168  * enum nl80211_s1g_short_beacon_attrs - S1G short beacon data
8169  *
8170  * @__NL80211_S1G_SHORT_BEACON_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
8171  *
8172  * @NL80211_S1G_SHORT_BEACON_ATTR_HEAD: Short beacon head (binary).
8173  * @NL80211_S1G_SHORT_BEACON_ATTR_TAIL: Short beacon tail (binary).
8174  *
8175  * @__NL80211_S1G_SHORT_BEACON_ATTR_LAST: Internal
8176  * @NL80211_S1G_SHORT_BEACON_ATTR_MAX: Highest attribute
8177  */
8178 enum nl80211_s1g_short_beacon_attrs {
8179 	__NL80211_S1G_SHORT_BEACON_ATTR_INVALID,
8180 
8181 	NL80211_S1G_SHORT_BEACON_ATTR_HEAD,
8182 	NL80211_S1G_SHORT_BEACON_ATTR_TAIL,
8183 
8184 	/* keep last */
8185 	__NL80211_S1G_SHORT_BEACON_ATTR_LAST,
8186 	NL80211_S1G_SHORT_BEACON_ATTR_MAX =
8187 		__NL80211_S1G_SHORT_BEACON_ATTR_LAST - 1
8188 };
8189 
8190 #endif /* __LINUX_NL80211_H */
8191